]> gcc.gnu.org Git - gcc.git/blob - gcc/dwarf2out.c
dwarf2out.c (modified_type_die): Do not call type_main_variant for vectors.
[gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from the GNU C compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7
8 This file is part of GCC.
9
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
14
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
19
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
23 02111-1307, USA. */
24
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
36
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "tree.h"
40 #include "flags.h"
41 #include "rtl.h"
42 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
43 #include "regs.h"
44 #include "insn-config.h"
45 #include "reload.h"
46 #include "function.h"
47 #include "output.h"
48 #include "expr.h"
49 #include "libfuncs.h"
50 #include "except.h"
51 #include "dwarf2.h"
52 #include "dwarf2out.h"
53 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
54 #include "toplev.h"
55 #include "varray.h"
56 #include "ggc.h"
57 #include "md5.h"
58 #include "tm_p.h"
59 #include "diagnostic.h"
60 #include "debug.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "langhooks.h"
63 #include "hashtable.h"
64
65 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
66 static void dwarf2out_source_line PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
67 #endif
68
69 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
70 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
71 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
72 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
73 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
74 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
75 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
76 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
77 CIE = Common Information Entry
78 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
79 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
80 FDE = Frame Description Entry
81 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
82 how to restore registers
83
84 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
85 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
86
87 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
88 translation unit. */
89
90 int
91 dwarf2out_do_frame ()
92 {
93 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
94 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
95 #ifdef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
96 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
97 #endif
98 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
99 || flag_unwind_tables
100 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
101 #endif
102 );
103 }
104
105 /* The number of the current function definition for which debugging
106 information is being generated. These numbers range from 1 up to the
107 maximum number of function definitions contained within the current
108 compilation unit. These numbers are used to create unique label id's
109 unique to each function definition. */
110 unsigned current_funcdef_number = 0;
111
112 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
113 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
114 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
115 #endif
116
117 /* Default version of targetm.eh_frame_section. Note this must appear
118 outside the DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO || DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO macro
119 guards. */
120
121 void
122 default_eh_frame_section ()
123 {
124 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
125 named_section_flags (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, SECTION_WRITE);
126 #else
127 tree label = get_file_function_name ('F');
128
129 data_section ();
130 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
131 ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
132 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
133 #endif
134 }
135
136 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
137
138 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
139 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
140 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
141 #endif
142
143 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
144 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
145 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
146
147 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
148 Information instructions. The register number, offset
149 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
150 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
151
152 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct
153 {
154 unsigned long dw_cfi_reg_num;
155 long int dw_cfi_offset;
156 const char *dw_cfi_addr;
157 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_cfi_loc;
158 }
159 dw_cfi_oprnd;
160
161 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct
162 {
163 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
164 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
165 dw_cfi_oprnd dw_cfi_oprnd1;
166 dw_cfi_oprnd dw_cfi_oprnd2;
167 }
168 dw_cfi_node;
169
170 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
171 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
172 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
173 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
174 of this structure. */
175 typedef struct cfa_loc
176 {
177 unsigned long reg;
178 long offset;
179 long base_offset;
180 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
181 } dw_cfa_location;
182
183 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
184 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
185 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
186 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
187 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
188
189 typedef struct dw_fde_struct
190 {
191 const char *dw_fde_begin;
192 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
193 const char *dw_fde_end;
194 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
195 unsigned funcdef_number;
196 unsigned nothrow : 1;
197 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
198 }
199 dw_fde_node;
200
201 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
202 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
203
204 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
205 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
206 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
207 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
208 pointers. */
209 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
210 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
211 #endif
212
213 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
214 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
215 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
216 as PTR_SIZE. */
217
218 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
219 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
220 #endif
221
222 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
223
224 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
225 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
226 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
227
228 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
229 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
230 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
231 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
232 #else
233 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
234 #endif
235 #endif
236
237 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
238 information for each routine. */
239 static dw_fde_ref fde_table;
240
241 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
242 static unsigned fde_table_allocated;
243
244 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
245 static unsigned fde_table_in_use;
246
247 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
248 fde_table. */
249 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
250
251 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
252 static dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
253
254 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
255 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
256 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
257 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
258 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
259
260 struct ht *debug_str_hash;
261
262 struct indirect_string_node
263 {
264 struct ht_identifier id;
265 unsigned int refcount;
266 unsigned int form;
267 char *label;
268 };
269
270 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
271
272 static char *stripattributes PARAMS ((const char *));
273 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
274 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi PARAMS ((void));
275 static void add_cfi PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref));
276 static void add_fde_cfi PARAMS ((const char *, dw_cfi_ref));
277 static void lookup_cfa_1 PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref,
278 dw_cfa_location *));
279 static void lookup_cfa PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *));
280 static void reg_save PARAMS ((const char *, unsigned,
281 unsigned, long));
282 static void initial_return_save PARAMS ((rtx));
283 static long stack_adjust_offset PARAMS ((rtx));
284 static void output_cfi PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int));
285 static void output_call_frame_info PARAMS ((int));
286 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust PARAMS ((rtx));
287 static void queue_reg_save PARAMS ((const char *, rtx, long));
288 static void flush_queued_reg_saves PARAMS ((void));
289 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save PARAMS ((rtx));
290 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr PARAMS ((rtx, const char *));
291
292 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
293 static void output_cfa_loc PARAMS ((dw_cfi_ref));
294 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *,
295 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *));
296 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
297 PARAMS ((dw_cfa_location *));
298 static void def_cfa_1 PARAMS ((const char *,
299 dw_cfa_location *));
300
301 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
302 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
303 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
304 #endif
305
306 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
307 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
308 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
309
310 /* Pseudo-op for defining a new section. */
311 #ifndef SECTION_ASM_OP
312 #define SECTION_ASM_OP "\t.section\t"
313 #endif
314
315 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
316 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
317 #endif
318
319 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
320 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
321 #endif
322
323 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
324 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
325 #endif
326
327 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
328 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
329 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
330 #define CIE_LENGTH_LABEL "LLCIE"
331 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
332 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
333 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
334 #define FDE_LENGTH_LABEL "LLFDE"
335 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
336 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
337 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
338 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
339 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
340
341 /* Definitions of defaults for various types of primitive assembly language
342 output operations. These may be overridden from within the tm.h file,
343 but typically, that is unnecessary. */
344
345 #ifdef SET_ASM_OP
346 #ifndef ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL
347 #define ASM_OUTPUT_DEFINE_LABEL_DIFFERENCE_SYMBOL(FILE, SY, HI, LO) \
348 do { \
349 fprintf (FILE, "%s", SET_ASM_OP); \
350 assemble_name (FILE, SY); \
351 fputc (',', FILE); \
352 assemble_name (FILE, HI); \
353 fputc ('-', FILE); \
354 assemble_name (FILE, LO); \
355 } while (0)
356 #endif
357 #endif
358
359 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
360 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
361 registers. */
362 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
363 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
364 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
365 #else
366 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
367 #endif
368 #endif
369
370 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
371 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
372 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
373 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
374 #endif
375
376 /* The offset from the incoming value of %sp to the top of the stack frame
377 for the current function. */
378 #ifndef INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
379 #define INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET 0
380 #endif
381 \f
382 /* Hook used by __throw. */
383
384 rtx
385 expand_builtin_dwarf_fp_regnum ()
386 {
387 return GEN_INT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM));
388 }
389
390 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
391 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
392
393 static inline char *
394 stripattributes (s)
395 const char *s;
396 {
397 char *stripped = xmalloc (strlen (s) + 2);
398 char *p = stripped;
399
400 *p++ = '*';
401
402 while (*s && *s != ',')
403 *p++ = *s++;
404
405 *p = '\0';
406 return stripped;
407 }
408
409 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
410
411 void
412 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (address)
413 tree address;
414 {
415 int i;
416 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
417 rtx addr = expand_expr (address, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, 0);
418 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
419
420 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS; i++)
421 {
422 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
423 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (reg_raw_mode[i]);
424
425 if (offset < 0)
426 continue;
427
428 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
429 }
430 }
431
432 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
433
434 static const char *
435 dwarf_cfi_name (cfi_opc)
436 unsigned cfi_opc;
437 {
438 switch (cfi_opc)
439 {
440 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
441 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
442 case DW_CFA_offset:
443 return "DW_CFA_offset";
444 case DW_CFA_restore:
445 return "DW_CFA_restore";
446 case DW_CFA_nop:
447 return "DW_CFA_nop";
448 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
449 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
450 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
451 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
452 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
453 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
454 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
455 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
456 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
457 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
458 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
459 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
460 case DW_CFA_undefined:
461 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
462 case DW_CFA_same_value:
463 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
464 case DW_CFA_register:
465 return "DW_CFA_register";
466 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
467 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
468 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
469 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
470 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
471 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
472 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
473 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
474 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
475 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
476
477 /* DWARF 3 */
478 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
479 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
480 case DW_CFA_expression:
481 return "DW_CFA_expression";
482 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
483 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
484 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
485 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
486 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
487 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
488
489 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
490 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
491 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
492
493 /* GNU extensions */
494 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
495 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
496 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
497 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
498 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
499 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
500
501 default:
502 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
503 }
504 }
505
506 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
507
508 static inline dw_cfi_ref
509 new_cfi ()
510 {
511 dw_cfi_ref cfi = (dw_cfi_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
512
513 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
514 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
515 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
516
517 return cfi;
518 }
519
520 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
521
522 static inline void
523 add_cfi (list_head, cfi)
524 dw_cfi_ref *list_head;
525 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
526 {
527 dw_cfi_ref *p;
528
529 /* Find the end of the chain. */
530 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
531 ;
532
533 *p = cfi;
534 }
535
536 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
537
538 char *
539 dwarf2out_cfi_label ()
540 {
541 static char label[20];
542 static unsigned long label_num = 0;
543
544 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", label_num++);
545 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
546 return label;
547 }
548
549 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
550 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
551
552 static void
553 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi)
554 const char *label;
555 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
556 {
557 if (label)
558 {
559 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
560
561 if (*label == 0)
562 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
563
564 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
565 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
566 {
567 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
568
569 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label = xstrdup (label);
570
571 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
572 xcfi = new_cfi ();
573 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
574 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
575 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
576 }
577
578 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
579 }
580
581 else
582 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
583 }
584
585 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
586
587 static inline void
588 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc)
589 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
590 dw_cfa_location *loc;
591 {
592 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
593 {
594 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
595 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
596 break;
597 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
598 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
599 break;
600 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
601 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
602 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
603 break;
604 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
605 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
606 break;
607 default:
608 break;
609 }
610 }
611
612 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
613
614 static void
615 lookup_cfa (loc)
616 dw_cfa_location *loc;
617 {
618 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
619
620 loc->reg = (unsigned long) -1;
621 loc->offset = 0;
622 loc->indirect = 0;
623 loc->base_offset = 0;
624
625 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
626 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
627
628 if (fde_table_in_use)
629 {
630 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
631 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
632 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
633 }
634 }
635
636 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
637 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
638
639 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
640 from the CFA. */
641 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
642
643 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
644 static long args_size;
645
646 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
647 static long old_args_size;
648
649 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
650 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
651 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
652
653 void
654 dwarf2out_def_cfa (label, reg, offset)
655 const char *label;
656 unsigned reg;
657 long offset;
658 {
659 dw_cfa_location loc;
660 loc.indirect = 0;
661 loc.base_offset = 0;
662 loc.reg = reg;
663 loc.offset = offset;
664 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
665 }
666
667 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
668 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
669
670 static void
671 def_cfa_1 (label, loc_p)
672 const char *label;
673 dw_cfa_location *loc_p;
674 {
675 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
676 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
677
678 cfa = *loc_p;
679 loc = *loc_p;
680
681 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
682 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
683
684 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
685 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
686
687 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
688 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
689 && loc.indirect == old_cfa.indirect
690 && (loc.indirect == 0 || loc.base_offset == old_cfa.base_offset))
691 return;
692
693 cfi = new_cfi ();
694
695 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
696 {
697 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction,
698 indicating the CFA register did not change but the offset
699 did. */
700 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
701 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
702 }
703
704 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
705 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset && old_cfa.reg != (unsigned long) -1
706 && !loc.indirect)
707 {
708 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
709 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
710 offset has not changed. */
711 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
712 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
713 }
714 #endif
715
716 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
717 {
718 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
719 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
720 the specified offset. */
721 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
722 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
723 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
724 }
725 else
726 {
727 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
728 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
729 register-offset pair is available. */
730 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
731
732 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
733 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc);
734 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
735 }
736
737 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
738 }
739
740 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
741 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
742 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
743 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
744
745 static void
746 reg_save (label, reg, sreg, offset)
747 const char *label;
748 unsigned reg;
749 unsigned sreg;
750 long offset;
751 {
752 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
753
754 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
755
756 /* The following comparison is correct. -1 is used to indicate that
757 the value isn't a register number. */
758 if (sreg == (unsigned int) -1)
759 {
760 if (reg & ~0x3f)
761 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
762 the long form. */
763 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
764 else
765 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
766
767 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
768 {
769 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
770 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
771 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
772 description. */
773 long check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
774
775 if (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT != offset)
776 abort ();
777 }
778 #endif
779 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
780 if (offset < 0)
781 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
782
783 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
784 }
785 else if (sreg == reg)
786 /* We could emit a DW_CFA_same_value in this case, but don't bother. */
787 return;
788 else
789 {
790 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
791 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
792 }
793
794 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
795 }
796
797 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
798 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
799 from the previous frame's window save area.
800
801 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
802 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
803
804 void
805 dwarf2out_window_save (label)
806 const char *label;
807 {
808 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
809
810 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
811 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
812 }
813
814 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
815 pushed onto the stack. */
816
817 void
818 dwarf2out_args_size (label, size)
819 const char *label;
820 long size;
821 {
822 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
823
824 if (size == old_args_size)
825 return;
826
827 old_args_size = size;
828
829 cfi = new_cfi ();
830 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
831 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
832 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
833 }
834
835 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
836 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
837
838 void
839 dwarf2out_reg_save (label, reg, offset)
840 const char *label;
841 unsigned reg;
842 long offset;
843 {
844 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), -1, offset);
845 }
846
847 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
848 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
849
850 void
851 dwarf2out_return_save (label, offset)
852 const char *label;
853 long offset;
854 {
855 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, -1, offset);
856 }
857
858 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
859 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
860
861 void
862 dwarf2out_return_reg (label, sreg)
863 const char *label;
864 unsigned sreg;
865 {
866 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, sreg, 0);
867 }
868
869 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
870 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
871
872 static void
873 initial_return_save (rtl)
874 rtx rtl;
875 {
876 unsigned int reg = (unsigned int) -1;
877 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
878
879 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
880 {
881 case REG:
882 /* RA is in a register. */
883 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
884 break;
885
886 case MEM:
887 /* RA is on the stack. */
888 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
889 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
890 {
891 case REG:
892 if (REGNO (rtl) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
893 abort ();
894 offset = 0;
895 break;
896
897 case PLUS:
898 if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
899 abort ();
900 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
901 break;
902
903 case MINUS:
904 if (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
905 abort ();
906 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
907 break;
908
909 default:
910 abort ();
911 }
912
913 break;
914
915 case PLUS:
916 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
917 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
918 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
919 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != CONST_INT)
920 abort ();
921 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
922 return;
923
924 default:
925 abort ();
926 }
927
928 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
929 }
930
931 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
932 contains. */
933
934 static long
935 stack_adjust_offset (pattern)
936 rtx pattern;
937 {
938 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
939 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
940 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
941 enum rtx_code code;
942
943 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
944 {
945 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
946 code = GET_CODE (src);
947 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
948 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
949 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
950 return 0;
951
952 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
953 }
954 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == MEM)
955 {
956 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
957 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
958 code = GET_CODE (src);
959
960 if ((code != PRE_DEC && code != PRE_INC && code != PRE_MODIFY)
961 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx)
962 return 0;
963
964 if (code == PRE_MODIFY)
965 {
966 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
967
968 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
969 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != PLUS ||
970 GET_CODE (val) != CONST_INT)
971 abort ();
972
973 offset = -INTVAL (val);
974 }
975 else
976 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
977 }
978 else
979 return 0;
980
981 if (code == PLUS || code == PRE_INC)
982 offset = -offset;
983
984 return offset;
985 }
986
987 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
988 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
989 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
990
991 static void
992 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn)
993 rtx insn;
994 {
995 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
996 const char *label;
997 int i;
998
999 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
1000 {
1001 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1002 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1003 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1004 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1005 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1006 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1007 if (GET_CODE (insn) != CALL)
1008 abort ();
1009
1010 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1011 return;
1012 }
1013
1014 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1015 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1016 else if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1017 return;
1018
1019 if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
1020 {
1021 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1022 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1023 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1024 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1025 offset = -args_size;
1026 #else
1027 offset = args_size;
1028 #endif
1029 }
1030 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1031 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1032 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1033 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1034 {
1035 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1036 for them. */
1037 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1038 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1039 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1040 }
1041 else
1042 return;
1043
1044 if (offset == 0)
1045 return;
1046
1047 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1048 cfa.offset += offset;
1049
1050 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1051 offset = -offset;
1052 #endif
1053
1054 args_size += offset;
1055 if (args_size < 0)
1056 args_size = 0;
1057
1058 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1059 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1060 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1061 }
1062
1063 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1064 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1065 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1066
1067 struct queued_reg_save
1068 {
1069 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1070 rtx reg;
1071 long cfa_offset;
1072 };
1073
1074 static struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1075 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1076
1077 static void
1078 queue_reg_save (label, reg, offset)
1079 const char *label;
1080 rtx reg;
1081 long offset;
1082 {
1083 struct queued_reg_save *q = (struct queued_reg_save *) xmalloc (sizeof (*q));
1084
1085 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1086 q->reg = reg;
1087 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1088 queued_reg_saves = q;
1089
1090 last_reg_save_label = label;
1091 }
1092
1093 static void
1094 flush_queued_reg_saves ()
1095 {
1096 struct queued_reg_save *q, *next;
1097
1098 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q ; q = next)
1099 {
1100 dwarf2out_reg_save (last_reg_save_label, REGNO (q->reg), q->cfa_offset);
1101 next = q->next;
1102 free (q);
1103 }
1104
1105 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1106 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1107 }
1108
1109 static bool
1110 clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn)
1111 rtx insn;
1112 {
1113 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1114
1115 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q ; q = q->next)
1116 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1117 return true;
1118
1119 return false;
1120 }
1121
1122
1123 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1124 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1125 value, not an offset. */
1126 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1127
1128 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1129 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1130 address) or saves a register to the stack. LABEL indicates the
1131 address of EXPR.
1132
1133 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1134 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1135 users need not read the source code.
1136
1137 The High-Level Picture
1138
1139 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1140 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1141 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1142 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1143 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1144
1145 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1146 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1147 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1148 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1149 saves. This also seems to work.
1150
1151 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1152 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1153 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1154 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1155
1156 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1157 offset is non-zero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1158 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1159 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1160
1161 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1162
1163 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1164 consists of a register and an offset.
1165 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1166 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1167 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1168 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1169 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1170 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1171 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1172
1173 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1174 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1175 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1176 cfa_temp.offset.
1177
1178 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1179 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1180 and cfa_temp.offset.
1181
1182 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1183 stack.
1184
1185 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1186 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1187 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1188
1189 The Rules
1190
1191 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1192 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1193
1194 Rule 1:
1195 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1196 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1197 cfa.offset unchanged
1198 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1199 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1200
1201 Rule 2:
1202 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1203 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1204 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1205 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1206 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1207 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1208
1209 Rule 3:
1210 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1211 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1212 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1213
1214 Rule 4:
1215 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1216 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1217 <reg1> != sp
1218 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1219 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1220 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1221
1222 Rule 5:
1223 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1224 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1225 <reg1> != sp
1226 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1227 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1228
1229 Rule 6:
1230 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1231 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1232 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1233
1234 Rule 7:
1235 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1236 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1237 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1238
1239 Rule 8:
1240 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1241 effects: none
1242
1243 Rule 9:
1244 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1245 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1246 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1247
1248 Rule 10:
1249 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1250 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1251 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1252 cfa.reg = sp
1253 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1254
1255 Rule 11:
1256 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1257 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1258 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1259 cfa.reg = sp
1260 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1261
1262 Rule 12:
1263 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1264
1265 <reg2>)
1266 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1267 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1268
1269 Rule 13:
1270 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1271 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1272 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1273
1274 Rule 14:
1275 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1276 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1277 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1278 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem) */
1279
1280 static void
1281 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (expr, label)
1282 rtx expr;
1283 const char *label;
1284 {
1285 rtx src, dest;
1286 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1287
1288 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1289 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1290 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1291 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1292 flag is set in them. */
1293 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1294 {
1295 int par_index;
1296 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1297
1298 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1299 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1300 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1301 || par_index == 0))
1302 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1303
1304 return;
1305 }
1306
1307 if (GET_CODE (expr) != SET)
1308 abort ();
1309
1310 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1311 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1312
1313 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1314 {
1315 case REG:
1316 /* Rule 1 */
1317 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1318 relative to the current CFA register. */
1319 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1320 {
1321 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1322 case REG:
1323 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1324 /* OK. */
1325 ;
1326 else
1327 abort ();
1328
1329 /* We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1330 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1331 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1332 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1333 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1334 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1335 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1336 break;
1337
1338 case PLUS:
1339 case MINUS:
1340 case LO_SUM:
1341 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1342 {
1343 /* Rule 2 */
1344 /* Adjusting SP. */
1345 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1346 {
1347 case CONST_INT:
1348 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1349 break;
1350 case REG:
1351 if ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1)) != cfa_temp.reg)
1352 abort ();
1353 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1354 break;
1355 default:
1356 abort ();
1357 }
1358
1359 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1360 {
1361 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1362 if (cfa.reg != (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
1363 abort ();
1364 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1365 }
1366 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1367 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1368 ;
1369 else if (XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx)
1370 abort ();
1371
1372 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1373 offset = -offset;
1374 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1375 cfa.offset += offset;
1376 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1377 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1378 }
1379 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1380 {
1381 /* Rule 3 */
1382 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1383 or adjusting the FP */
1384 if (! frame_pointer_needed)
1385 abort ();
1386
1387 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1388 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1389 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1390 {
1391 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1392 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1393 offset = -offset;
1394 cfa.offset += offset;
1395 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1396 }
1397 else
1398 abort ();
1399 }
1400 else
1401 {
1402 if (GET_CODE (src) == MINUS)
1403 abort ();
1404
1405 /* Rule 4 */
1406 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1407 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1408 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1409 {
1410 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1411 into the FP later on. */
1412 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1413 cfa.offset += offset;
1414 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1415 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1416 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1417 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1418 }
1419
1420 /* Rule 5 */
1421 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == REG
1422 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1423 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1424 {
1425 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1426 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1427 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1428 abort ();
1429 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1430 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1431 }
1432
1433 /* Rule 9 */
1434 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1435 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1436 {
1437 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1438 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1439 }
1440 else
1441 abort ();
1442 }
1443 break;
1444
1445 /* Rule 6 */
1446 case CONST_INT:
1447 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1448 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1449 break;
1450
1451 /* Rule 7 */
1452 case IOR:
1453 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) != REG
1454 || (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) != cfa_temp.reg
1455 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1456 abort ();
1457
1458 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1459 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1460 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1461 break;
1462
1463 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1464 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1465 /* Rule 8 */
1466 case HIGH:
1467 break;
1468
1469 default:
1470 abort ();
1471 }
1472
1473 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1474 break;
1475
1476 case MEM:
1477 if (GET_CODE (src) != REG)
1478 abort ();
1479
1480 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1481 CFA register. */
1482 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1483 {
1484 /* Rule 10 */
1485 /* With a push. */
1486 case PRE_MODIFY:
1487 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1488 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1)) != CONST_INT)
1489 abort ();
1490 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1491
1492 if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1493 || cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1494 abort ();
1495
1496 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1497 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1498 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1499
1500 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1501 break;
1502
1503 /* Rule 11 */
1504 case PRE_INC:
1505 case PRE_DEC:
1506 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1507 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1508 offset = -offset;
1509
1510 if (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1511 || cfa_store.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1512 abort ();
1513
1514 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1515 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1516 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1517
1518 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1519 break;
1520
1521 /* Rule 12 */
1522 /* With an offset. */
1523 case PLUS:
1524 case MINUS:
1525 case LO_SUM:
1526 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) != CONST_INT)
1527 abort ();
1528 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1529 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1530 offset = -offset;
1531
1532 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1533 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1534 else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1535 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1536 else
1537 abort ();
1538 break;
1539
1540 /* Rule 13 */
1541 /* Without an offset. */
1542 case REG:
1543 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1544 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1545 else if (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1546 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1547 else
1548 abort ();
1549 break;
1550
1551 /* Rule 14 */
1552 case POST_INC:
1553 if (cfa_temp.reg != (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)))
1554 abort ();
1555 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1556 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1557 break;
1558
1559 default:
1560 abort ();
1561 }
1562
1563 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1564 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1565 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1566 {
1567 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1568
1569 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1570 {
1571 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1572 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1573 on the ARM. */
1574 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1575 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, offset);
1576 break;
1577 }
1578 else
1579 {
1580 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1581 calculate the CFA. */
1582 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1583
1584 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
1585 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1586 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
1587 abort ();
1588
1589 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1590 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1591 cfa.indirect = 1;
1592 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1593 break;
1594 }
1595 }
1596
1597 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1598 queue_reg_save (label, src, offset);
1599 break;
1600
1601 default:
1602 abort ();
1603 }
1604 }
1605
1606 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1607 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1608 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state. */
1609
1610 void
1611 dwarf2out_frame_debug (insn)
1612 rtx insn;
1613 {
1614 const char *label;
1615 rtx src;
1616
1617 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1618 {
1619 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1620 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1621
1622 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1623 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1624 if (cfa.reg != (unsigned long) DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM))
1625 abort ();
1626
1627 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1628 cfa_store = cfa;
1629 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1630 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1631 return;
1632 }
1633
1634 if (GET_CODE (insn) != INSN || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1635 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1636
1637 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1638 {
1639 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1640 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn);
1641
1642 return;
1643 }
1644
1645 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1646 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1647 if (src)
1648 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1649 else
1650 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1651
1652 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1653 }
1654
1655 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
1656
1657 static void
1658 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh)
1659 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1660 dw_fde_ref fde;
1661 int for_eh;
1662 {
1663 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
1664 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1665 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
1666 "DW_CFA_advance_loc 0x%lx",
1667 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
1668 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
1669 {
1670 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1671 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
1672 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx",
1673 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
1674 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1675 }
1676 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
1677 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
1678 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num & 0x3f)),
1679 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx",
1680 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num);
1681 else
1682 {
1683 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
1684 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
1685
1686 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
1687 {
1688 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1689 if (for_eh)
1690 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
1691 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
1692 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
1693 NULL);
1694 else
1695 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
1696 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
1697 break;
1698
1699 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1700 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1701 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1702 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1703 break;
1704
1705 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1706 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1707 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1708 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1709 break;
1710
1711 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1712 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1713 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1714 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1715 break;
1716
1717 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1718 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
1719 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
1720 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
1721 break;
1722
1723 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1724 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1725 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1726 NULL);
1727 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1728 break;
1729
1730 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1731 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1732 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1733 NULL);
1734 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1735 break;
1736
1737 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1738 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1739 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1740 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1741 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1742 NULL);
1743 break;
1744
1745 case DW_CFA_register:
1746 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1747 NULL);
1748 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num,
1749 NULL);
1750 break;
1751
1752 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1753 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1754 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1755 break;
1756
1757 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1758 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
1759 break;
1760
1761 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1762 break;
1763
1764 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1765 case DW_CFA_expression:
1766 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
1767 break;
1768
1769 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
1770 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
1771 abort ();
1772
1773 default:
1774 break;
1775 }
1776 }
1777 }
1778
1779 /* Output the call frame information used to used to record information
1780 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
1781 location of saved registers. */
1782
1783 static void
1784 output_call_frame_info (for_eh)
1785 int for_eh;
1786 {
1787 unsigned int i;
1788 dw_fde_ref fde;
1789 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1790 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
1791 int any_lsda_needed = 0;
1792 char augmentation[6];
1793 int augmentation_size;
1794 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1795 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1796 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
1797
1798 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit any
1799 EH unwind information. */
1800 if (for_eh)
1801 {
1802 int any_eh_needed = flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
1803
1804 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
1805 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
1806 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = 1;
1807 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow)
1808 any_eh_needed = 1;
1809
1810 if (! any_eh_needed)
1811 return;
1812 }
1813
1814 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
1815 if (flag_debug_asm)
1816 app_enable ();
1817
1818 if (for_eh)
1819 (*targetm.asm_out.eh_frame_section) ();
1820 else
1821 named_section_flags (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
1822
1823 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
1824 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
1825
1826 /* Output the CIE. */
1827 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
1828 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
1829 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
1830 "Length of Common Information Entry");
1831 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
1832
1833 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
1834 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
1835 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
1836 (for_eh ? 0 : DW_CIE_ID),
1837 "CIE Identifier Tag");
1838
1839 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
1840
1841 augmentation[0] = 0;
1842 augmentation_size = 0;
1843 if (for_eh)
1844 {
1845 char *p;
1846
1847 /* Augmentation:
1848 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
1849 augmentation section.
1850 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
1851 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
1852 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
1853 FDE code pointers.
1854 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
1855 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
1856
1857 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
1858 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
1859 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
1860
1861 p = augmentation + 1;
1862 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
1863 {
1864 *p++ = 'P';
1865 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
1866 }
1867 if (any_lsda_needed)
1868 {
1869 *p++ = 'L';
1870 augmentation_size += 1;
1871 }
1872 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
1873 {
1874 *p++ = 'R';
1875 augmentation_size += 1;
1876 }
1877 if (p > augmentation + 1)
1878 {
1879 augmentation[0] = 'z';
1880 *p = '\0';
1881 }
1882
1883 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
1884 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
1885 {
1886 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
1887 + 4 /* CIE Id */
1888 + 1 /* CIE version */
1889 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
1890 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
1891 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
1892 + 1 /* RA column */
1893 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
1894 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
1895 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
1896
1897 augmentation_size += pad;
1898
1899 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
1900 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
1901 if (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) != 1)
1902 abort ();
1903 }
1904 }
1905
1906 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
1907 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
1908 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
1909 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
1910 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, "CIE RA Column");
1911
1912 if (augmentation[0])
1913 {
1914 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
1915 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
1916 {
1917 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
1918 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
1919 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
1920 eh_personality_libfunc, NULL);
1921 }
1922
1923 if (any_lsda_needed)
1924 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
1925 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
1926
1927 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
1928 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
1929 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
1930 }
1931
1932 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
1933 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
1934
1935 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
1936 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
1937 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
1938 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
1939
1940 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
1941 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
1942 {
1943 fde = &fde_table[i];
1944
1945 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
1946 if (for_eh && fde->nothrow && ! fde->uses_eh_lsda)
1947 continue;
1948
1949 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
1950 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
1951 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
1952 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
1953 "FDE Length");
1954 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
1955
1956 if (for_eh)
1957 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
1958 else
1959 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
1960 "FDE CIE offset");
1961
1962 if (for_eh)
1963 {
1964 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
1965 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin),
1966 "FDE initial location");
1967 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
1968 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
1969 "FDE address range");
1970 }
1971 else
1972 {
1973 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
1974 "FDE initial location");
1975 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
1976 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
1977 "FDE address range");
1978 }
1979
1980 if (augmentation[0])
1981 {
1982 if (any_lsda_needed)
1983 {
1984 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
1985
1986 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
1987 {
1988 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
1989 + 4 /* CIE offset */
1990 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
1991 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
1992 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
1993
1994 size += pad;
1995 if (size_of_uleb128 (size) != 1)
1996 abort ();
1997 }
1998
1999 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2000
2001 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2002 {
2003 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2004 fde->funcdef_number);
2005 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2006 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2007 "Language Specific Data Area");
2008 }
2009 else
2010 {
2011 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2012 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2013 dw2_asm_output_data
2014 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2015 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2016 }
2017 }
2018 else
2019 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2020 }
2021
2022 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2023 this FDE. */
2024 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2025 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2026 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2027
2028 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2029 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2030 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2031 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2032 }
2033
2034 #ifndef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2035 if (for_eh)
2036 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2037 #endif
2038 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2039 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2040 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2041 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2042 #endif
2043
2044 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2045 if (flag_debug_asm)
2046 app_disable ();
2047 }
2048
2049 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2050 the prologue. */
2051
2052 void
2053 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (line, file)
2054 unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2055 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2056 {
2057 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2058 dw_fde_ref fde;
2059
2060 current_function_func_begin_label = 0;
2061
2062 #ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
2063 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2064 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2065 be used. */
2066 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2067 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2068 return;
2069 #else
2070 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2071 return;
2072 #endif
2073
2074 current_funcdef_number++;
2075 function_section (current_function_decl);
2076 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2077 current_funcdef_number);
2078 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2079 current_funcdef_number);
2080 current_function_func_begin_label = get_identifier (label);
2081
2082 #ifdef IA64_UNWIND_INFO
2083 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2084 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2085 return;
2086 #endif
2087
2088 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2089 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2090 {
2091 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2092 fde_table
2093 = (dw_fde_ref) xrealloc (fde_table,
2094 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2095 }
2096
2097 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2098 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2099
2100 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2101 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2102 fde->dw_fde_begin = xstrdup (label);
2103 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
2104 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2105 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2106 fde->funcdef_number = current_funcdef_number;
2107 fde->nothrow = current_function_nothrow;
2108 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2109
2110 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2111
2112 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2113 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2114 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2115 if (file)
2116 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2117 #endif
2118 }
2119
2120 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2121 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2122 been generated. */
2123
2124 void
2125 dwarf2out_end_epilogue ()
2126 {
2127 dw_fde_ref fde;
2128 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2129
2130 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2131 function. */
2132 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL, current_funcdef_number);
2133 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2134 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2135 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2136 }
2137
2138 void
2139 dwarf2out_frame_init ()
2140 {
2141 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2142 fde_table = (dw_fde_ref) xcalloc (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2143 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2144 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2145
2146 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2147 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2148
2149 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2150 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2151 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2152 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2153 #endif
2154 }
2155
2156 void
2157 dwarf2out_frame_finish ()
2158 {
2159 /* Output call frame information. */
2160 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
2161 output_call_frame_info (0);
2162
2163 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2164 output_call_frame_info (1);
2165 }
2166 \f
2167 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2168 for emitting location expressions. */
2169
2170 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2171 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2172 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2173 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2174
2175 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2176 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2177 implementation are listed below. */
2178
2179 typedef enum
2180 {
2181 dw_val_class_addr,
2182 dw_val_class_offset,
2183 dw_val_class_loc,
2184 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2185 dw_val_class_range_list,
2186 dw_val_class_const,
2187 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2188 dw_val_class_long_long,
2189 dw_val_class_float,
2190 dw_val_class_flag,
2191 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2192 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2193 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2194 dw_val_class_lbl_offset,
2195 dw_val_class_str
2196 }
2197 dw_val_class;
2198
2199 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2200 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2201
2202 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct
2203 {
2204 unsigned long hi;
2205 unsigned long low;
2206 }
2207 dw_long_long_const;
2208
2209 /* Describe a floating point constant value. */
2210
2211 typedef struct dw_fp_struct
2212 {
2213 long *array;
2214 unsigned length;
2215 }
2216 dw_float_const;
2217
2218 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2219 represented internally. */
2220
2221 typedef struct dw_val_struct
2222 {
2223 dw_val_class val_class;
2224 union
2225 {
2226 rtx val_addr;
2227 long unsigned val_offset;
2228 dw_loc_list_ref val_loc_list;
2229 dw_loc_descr_ref val_loc;
2230 long int val_int;
2231 long unsigned val_unsigned;
2232 dw_long_long_const val_long_long;
2233 dw_float_const val_float;
2234 struct
2235 {
2236 dw_die_ref die;
2237 int external;
2238 } val_die_ref;
2239 unsigned val_fde_index;
2240 struct indirect_string_node *val_str;
2241 char *val_lbl_id;
2242 unsigned char val_flag;
2243 }
2244 v;
2245 }
2246 dw_val_node;
2247
2248 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2249 operations. */
2250
2251 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct
2252 {
2253 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2254 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2255 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2256 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2257 int dw_loc_addr;
2258 }
2259 dw_loc_descr_node;
2260
2261 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2262 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2263 their entire life. */
2264 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct
2265 {
2266 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2267 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2268 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2269 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2270 Only on head of list */
2271 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2272 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2273 } dw_loc_list_node;
2274
2275 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
2276 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr PARAMS ((enum dwarf_location_atom,
2277 unsigned long,
2278 unsigned long));
2279 static void add_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref *,
2280 dw_loc_descr_ref));
2281 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2282 static unsigned long size_of_locs PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2283 static void output_loc_operands PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2284 static void output_loc_sequence PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref));
2285
2286 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2287
2288 static const char *
2289 dwarf_stack_op_name (op)
2290 unsigned op;
2291 {
2292 switch (op)
2293 {
2294 case DW_OP_addr:
2295 return "DW_OP_addr";
2296 case DW_OP_deref:
2297 return "DW_OP_deref";
2298 case DW_OP_const1u:
2299 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2300 case DW_OP_const1s:
2301 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2302 case DW_OP_const2u:
2303 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2304 case DW_OP_const2s:
2305 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2306 case DW_OP_const4u:
2307 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2308 case DW_OP_const4s:
2309 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2310 case DW_OP_const8u:
2311 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2312 case DW_OP_const8s:
2313 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2314 case DW_OP_constu:
2315 return "DW_OP_constu";
2316 case DW_OP_consts:
2317 return "DW_OP_consts";
2318 case DW_OP_dup:
2319 return "DW_OP_dup";
2320 case DW_OP_drop:
2321 return "DW_OP_drop";
2322 case DW_OP_over:
2323 return "DW_OP_over";
2324 case DW_OP_pick:
2325 return "DW_OP_pick";
2326 case DW_OP_swap:
2327 return "DW_OP_swap";
2328 case DW_OP_rot:
2329 return "DW_OP_rot";
2330 case DW_OP_xderef:
2331 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2332 case DW_OP_abs:
2333 return "DW_OP_abs";
2334 case DW_OP_and:
2335 return "DW_OP_and";
2336 case DW_OP_div:
2337 return "DW_OP_div";
2338 case DW_OP_minus:
2339 return "DW_OP_minus";
2340 case DW_OP_mod:
2341 return "DW_OP_mod";
2342 case DW_OP_mul:
2343 return "DW_OP_mul";
2344 case DW_OP_neg:
2345 return "DW_OP_neg";
2346 case DW_OP_not:
2347 return "DW_OP_not";
2348 case DW_OP_or:
2349 return "DW_OP_or";
2350 case DW_OP_plus:
2351 return "DW_OP_plus";
2352 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2353 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2354 case DW_OP_shl:
2355 return "DW_OP_shl";
2356 case DW_OP_shr:
2357 return "DW_OP_shr";
2358 case DW_OP_shra:
2359 return "DW_OP_shra";
2360 case DW_OP_xor:
2361 return "DW_OP_xor";
2362 case DW_OP_bra:
2363 return "DW_OP_bra";
2364 case DW_OP_eq:
2365 return "DW_OP_eq";
2366 case DW_OP_ge:
2367 return "DW_OP_ge";
2368 case DW_OP_gt:
2369 return "DW_OP_gt";
2370 case DW_OP_le:
2371 return "DW_OP_le";
2372 case DW_OP_lt:
2373 return "DW_OP_lt";
2374 case DW_OP_ne:
2375 return "DW_OP_ne";
2376 case DW_OP_skip:
2377 return "DW_OP_skip";
2378 case DW_OP_lit0:
2379 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2380 case DW_OP_lit1:
2381 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2382 case DW_OP_lit2:
2383 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2384 case DW_OP_lit3:
2385 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2386 case DW_OP_lit4:
2387 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2388 case DW_OP_lit5:
2389 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2390 case DW_OP_lit6:
2391 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2392 case DW_OP_lit7:
2393 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2394 case DW_OP_lit8:
2395 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2396 case DW_OP_lit9:
2397 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2398 case DW_OP_lit10:
2399 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2400 case DW_OP_lit11:
2401 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2402 case DW_OP_lit12:
2403 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2404 case DW_OP_lit13:
2405 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2406 case DW_OP_lit14:
2407 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2408 case DW_OP_lit15:
2409 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2410 case DW_OP_lit16:
2411 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2412 case DW_OP_lit17:
2413 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2414 case DW_OP_lit18:
2415 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2416 case DW_OP_lit19:
2417 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2418 case DW_OP_lit20:
2419 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2420 case DW_OP_lit21:
2421 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2422 case DW_OP_lit22:
2423 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2424 case DW_OP_lit23:
2425 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2426 case DW_OP_lit24:
2427 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2428 case DW_OP_lit25:
2429 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2430 case DW_OP_lit26:
2431 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2432 case DW_OP_lit27:
2433 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2434 case DW_OP_lit28:
2435 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2436 case DW_OP_lit29:
2437 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2438 case DW_OP_lit30:
2439 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2440 case DW_OP_lit31:
2441 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2442 case DW_OP_reg0:
2443 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2444 case DW_OP_reg1:
2445 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2446 case DW_OP_reg2:
2447 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2448 case DW_OP_reg3:
2449 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2450 case DW_OP_reg4:
2451 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2452 case DW_OP_reg5:
2453 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2454 case DW_OP_reg6:
2455 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2456 case DW_OP_reg7:
2457 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2458 case DW_OP_reg8:
2459 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2460 case DW_OP_reg9:
2461 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2462 case DW_OP_reg10:
2463 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2464 case DW_OP_reg11:
2465 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2466 case DW_OP_reg12:
2467 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2468 case DW_OP_reg13:
2469 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2470 case DW_OP_reg14:
2471 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2472 case DW_OP_reg15:
2473 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2474 case DW_OP_reg16:
2475 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2476 case DW_OP_reg17:
2477 return "DW_OP_reg17";
2478 case DW_OP_reg18:
2479 return "DW_OP_reg18";
2480 case DW_OP_reg19:
2481 return "DW_OP_reg19";
2482 case DW_OP_reg20:
2483 return "DW_OP_reg20";
2484 case DW_OP_reg21:
2485 return "DW_OP_reg21";
2486 case DW_OP_reg22:
2487 return "DW_OP_reg22";
2488 case DW_OP_reg23:
2489 return "DW_OP_reg23";
2490 case DW_OP_reg24:
2491 return "DW_OP_reg24";
2492 case DW_OP_reg25:
2493 return "DW_OP_reg25";
2494 case DW_OP_reg26:
2495 return "DW_OP_reg26";
2496 case DW_OP_reg27:
2497 return "DW_OP_reg27";
2498 case DW_OP_reg28:
2499 return "DW_OP_reg28";
2500 case DW_OP_reg29:
2501 return "DW_OP_reg29";
2502 case DW_OP_reg30:
2503 return "DW_OP_reg30";
2504 case DW_OP_reg31:
2505 return "DW_OP_reg31";
2506 case DW_OP_breg0:
2507 return "DW_OP_breg0";
2508 case DW_OP_breg1:
2509 return "DW_OP_breg1";
2510 case DW_OP_breg2:
2511 return "DW_OP_breg2";
2512 case DW_OP_breg3:
2513 return "DW_OP_breg3";
2514 case DW_OP_breg4:
2515 return "DW_OP_breg4";
2516 case DW_OP_breg5:
2517 return "DW_OP_breg5";
2518 case DW_OP_breg6:
2519 return "DW_OP_breg6";
2520 case DW_OP_breg7:
2521 return "DW_OP_breg7";
2522 case DW_OP_breg8:
2523 return "DW_OP_breg8";
2524 case DW_OP_breg9:
2525 return "DW_OP_breg9";
2526 case DW_OP_breg10:
2527 return "DW_OP_breg10";
2528 case DW_OP_breg11:
2529 return "DW_OP_breg11";
2530 case DW_OP_breg12:
2531 return "DW_OP_breg12";
2532 case DW_OP_breg13:
2533 return "DW_OP_breg13";
2534 case DW_OP_breg14:
2535 return "DW_OP_breg14";
2536 case DW_OP_breg15:
2537 return "DW_OP_breg15";
2538 case DW_OP_breg16:
2539 return "DW_OP_breg16";
2540 case DW_OP_breg17:
2541 return "DW_OP_breg17";
2542 case DW_OP_breg18:
2543 return "DW_OP_breg18";
2544 case DW_OP_breg19:
2545 return "DW_OP_breg19";
2546 case DW_OP_breg20:
2547 return "DW_OP_breg20";
2548 case DW_OP_breg21:
2549 return "DW_OP_breg21";
2550 case DW_OP_breg22:
2551 return "DW_OP_breg22";
2552 case DW_OP_breg23:
2553 return "DW_OP_breg23";
2554 case DW_OP_breg24:
2555 return "DW_OP_breg24";
2556 case DW_OP_breg25:
2557 return "DW_OP_breg25";
2558 case DW_OP_breg26:
2559 return "DW_OP_breg26";
2560 case DW_OP_breg27:
2561 return "DW_OP_breg27";
2562 case DW_OP_breg28:
2563 return "DW_OP_breg28";
2564 case DW_OP_breg29:
2565 return "DW_OP_breg29";
2566 case DW_OP_breg30:
2567 return "DW_OP_breg30";
2568 case DW_OP_breg31:
2569 return "DW_OP_breg31";
2570 case DW_OP_regx:
2571 return "DW_OP_regx";
2572 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2573 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
2574 case DW_OP_bregx:
2575 return "DW_OP_bregx";
2576 case DW_OP_piece:
2577 return "DW_OP_piece";
2578 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2579 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
2580 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2581 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
2582 case DW_OP_nop:
2583 return "DW_OP_nop";
2584 default:
2585 return "OP_<unknown>";
2586 }
2587 }
2588
2589 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
2590 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
2591 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
2592
2593 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
2594 new_loc_descr (op, oprnd1, oprnd2)
2595 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
2596 unsigned long oprnd1;
2597 unsigned long oprnd2;
2598 {
2599 /* Use xcalloc here so we clear out all of the long_long constant in
2600 the union. */
2601 dw_loc_descr_ref descr
2602 = (dw_loc_descr_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
2603
2604 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
2605 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2606 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
2607 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
2608 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
2609
2610 return descr;
2611 }
2612
2613
2614 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
2615
2616 static inline void
2617 add_loc_descr (list_head, descr)
2618 dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head;
2619 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
2620 {
2621 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
2622
2623 /* Find the end of the chain. */
2624 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
2625 ;
2626
2627 *d = descr;
2628 }
2629
2630 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
2631
2632 static unsigned long
2633 size_of_loc_descr (loc)
2634 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2635 {
2636 unsigned long size = 1;
2637
2638 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2639 {
2640 case DW_OP_addr:
2641 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
2642 break;
2643 case DW_OP_const1u:
2644 case DW_OP_const1s:
2645 size += 1;
2646 break;
2647 case DW_OP_const2u:
2648 case DW_OP_const2s:
2649 size += 2;
2650 break;
2651 case DW_OP_const4u:
2652 case DW_OP_const4s:
2653 size += 4;
2654 break;
2655 case DW_OP_const8u:
2656 case DW_OP_const8s:
2657 size += 8;
2658 break;
2659 case DW_OP_constu:
2660 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2661 break;
2662 case DW_OP_consts:
2663 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2664 break;
2665 case DW_OP_pick:
2666 size += 1;
2667 break;
2668 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2669 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2670 break;
2671 case DW_OP_skip:
2672 case DW_OP_bra:
2673 size += 2;
2674 break;
2675 case DW_OP_breg0:
2676 case DW_OP_breg1:
2677 case DW_OP_breg2:
2678 case DW_OP_breg3:
2679 case DW_OP_breg4:
2680 case DW_OP_breg5:
2681 case DW_OP_breg6:
2682 case DW_OP_breg7:
2683 case DW_OP_breg8:
2684 case DW_OP_breg9:
2685 case DW_OP_breg10:
2686 case DW_OP_breg11:
2687 case DW_OP_breg12:
2688 case DW_OP_breg13:
2689 case DW_OP_breg14:
2690 case DW_OP_breg15:
2691 case DW_OP_breg16:
2692 case DW_OP_breg17:
2693 case DW_OP_breg18:
2694 case DW_OP_breg19:
2695 case DW_OP_breg20:
2696 case DW_OP_breg21:
2697 case DW_OP_breg22:
2698 case DW_OP_breg23:
2699 case DW_OP_breg24:
2700 case DW_OP_breg25:
2701 case DW_OP_breg26:
2702 case DW_OP_breg27:
2703 case DW_OP_breg28:
2704 case DW_OP_breg29:
2705 case DW_OP_breg30:
2706 case DW_OP_breg31:
2707 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2708 break;
2709 case DW_OP_regx:
2710 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2711 break;
2712 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2713 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
2714 break;
2715 case DW_OP_bregx:
2716 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2717 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
2718 break;
2719 case DW_OP_piece:
2720 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
2721 break;
2722 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2723 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2724 size += 1;
2725 break;
2726 default:
2727 break;
2728 }
2729
2730 return size;
2731 }
2732
2733 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
2734
2735 static unsigned long
2736 size_of_locs (loc)
2737 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2738 {
2739 unsigned long size;
2740
2741 for (size = 0; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2742 {
2743 loc->dw_loc_addr = size;
2744 size += size_of_loc_descr (loc);
2745 }
2746
2747 return size;
2748 }
2749
2750 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
2751
2752 static void
2753 output_loc_operands (loc)
2754 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2755 {
2756 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2757 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2758
2759 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2760 {
2761 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2762 case DW_OP_addr:
2763 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2764 break;
2765 case DW_OP_const2u:
2766 case DW_OP_const2s:
2767 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2768 break;
2769 case DW_OP_const4u:
2770 case DW_OP_const4s:
2771 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2772 break;
2773 case DW_OP_const8u:
2774 case DW_OP_const8s:
2775 if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG < 64)
2776 abort ();
2777 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2778 break;
2779 case DW_OP_skip:
2780 case DW_OP_bra:
2781 {
2782 int offset;
2783
2784 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
2785 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2786 else
2787 abort ();
2788
2789 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
2790 }
2791 break;
2792 #else
2793 case DW_OP_addr:
2794 case DW_OP_const2u:
2795 case DW_OP_const2s:
2796 case DW_OP_const4u:
2797 case DW_OP_const4s:
2798 case DW_OP_const8u:
2799 case DW_OP_const8s:
2800 case DW_OP_skip:
2801 case DW_OP_bra:
2802 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
2803 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
2804 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
2805 only doing unwinding. */
2806 abort ();
2807 #endif
2808 case DW_OP_const1u:
2809 case DW_OP_const1s:
2810 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2811 break;
2812 case DW_OP_constu:
2813 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2814 break;
2815 case DW_OP_consts:
2816 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2817 break;
2818 case DW_OP_pick:
2819 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2820 break;
2821 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2822 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2823 break;
2824 case DW_OP_breg0:
2825 case DW_OP_breg1:
2826 case DW_OP_breg2:
2827 case DW_OP_breg3:
2828 case DW_OP_breg4:
2829 case DW_OP_breg5:
2830 case DW_OP_breg6:
2831 case DW_OP_breg7:
2832 case DW_OP_breg8:
2833 case DW_OP_breg9:
2834 case DW_OP_breg10:
2835 case DW_OP_breg11:
2836 case DW_OP_breg12:
2837 case DW_OP_breg13:
2838 case DW_OP_breg14:
2839 case DW_OP_breg15:
2840 case DW_OP_breg16:
2841 case DW_OP_breg17:
2842 case DW_OP_breg18:
2843 case DW_OP_breg19:
2844 case DW_OP_breg20:
2845 case DW_OP_breg21:
2846 case DW_OP_breg22:
2847 case DW_OP_breg23:
2848 case DW_OP_breg24:
2849 case DW_OP_breg25:
2850 case DW_OP_breg26:
2851 case DW_OP_breg27:
2852 case DW_OP_breg28:
2853 case DW_OP_breg29:
2854 case DW_OP_breg30:
2855 case DW_OP_breg31:
2856 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2857 break;
2858 case DW_OP_regx:
2859 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2860 break;
2861 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2862 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2863 break;
2864 case DW_OP_bregx:
2865 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2866 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2867 break;
2868 case DW_OP_piece:
2869 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2870 break;
2871 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2872 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2873 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2874 break;
2875 default:
2876 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2877 break;
2878 }
2879 }
2880
2881 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
2882
2883 static void
2884 output_loc_sequence (loc)
2885 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2886 {
2887 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2888 {
2889 /* Output the opcode. */
2890 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
2891 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
2892
2893 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2894 output_loc_operands (loc);
2895 }
2896 }
2897
2898 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
2899 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
2900
2901 static void
2902 output_cfa_loc (cfi)
2903 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2904 {
2905 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
2906 unsigned long size;
2907
2908 /* Output the size of the block. */
2909 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
2910 size = size_of_locs (loc);
2911 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
2912
2913 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
2914 output_loc_sequence (loc);
2915 }
2916
2917 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from
2918 a dw_cfa_location. */
2919
2920 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
2921 build_cfa_loc (cfa)
2922 dw_cfa_location *cfa;
2923 {
2924 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
2925
2926 if (cfa->indirect == 0)
2927 abort ();
2928
2929 if (cfa->base_offset)
2930 {
2931 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
2932 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
2933 else
2934 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2935 }
2936 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
2937 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
2938 else
2939 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
2940
2941 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2942 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2943 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2944 if (cfa->offset != 0)
2945 {
2946 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, cfa->offset, 0);
2947 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2948 }
2949
2950 return head;
2951 }
2952
2953 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
2954 descriptor sequence. */
2955
2956 static void
2957 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (cfa, loc)
2958 dw_cfa_location *cfa;
2959 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc;
2960 {
2961 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
2962 cfa->offset = 0;
2963 cfa->base_offset = 0;
2964 cfa->indirect = 0;
2965 cfa->reg = -1;
2966
2967 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
2968 {
2969 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
2970
2971 switch (op)
2972 {
2973 case DW_OP_reg0:
2974 case DW_OP_reg1:
2975 case DW_OP_reg2:
2976 case DW_OP_reg3:
2977 case DW_OP_reg4:
2978 case DW_OP_reg5:
2979 case DW_OP_reg6:
2980 case DW_OP_reg7:
2981 case DW_OP_reg8:
2982 case DW_OP_reg9:
2983 case DW_OP_reg10:
2984 case DW_OP_reg11:
2985 case DW_OP_reg12:
2986 case DW_OP_reg13:
2987 case DW_OP_reg14:
2988 case DW_OP_reg15:
2989 case DW_OP_reg16:
2990 case DW_OP_reg17:
2991 case DW_OP_reg18:
2992 case DW_OP_reg19:
2993 case DW_OP_reg20:
2994 case DW_OP_reg21:
2995 case DW_OP_reg22:
2996 case DW_OP_reg23:
2997 case DW_OP_reg24:
2998 case DW_OP_reg25:
2999 case DW_OP_reg26:
3000 case DW_OP_reg27:
3001 case DW_OP_reg28:
3002 case DW_OP_reg29:
3003 case DW_OP_reg30:
3004 case DW_OP_reg31:
3005 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3006 break;
3007 case DW_OP_regx:
3008 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3009 break;
3010 case DW_OP_breg0:
3011 case DW_OP_breg1:
3012 case DW_OP_breg2:
3013 case DW_OP_breg3:
3014 case DW_OP_breg4:
3015 case DW_OP_breg5:
3016 case DW_OP_breg6:
3017 case DW_OP_breg7:
3018 case DW_OP_breg8:
3019 case DW_OP_breg9:
3020 case DW_OP_breg10:
3021 case DW_OP_breg11:
3022 case DW_OP_breg12:
3023 case DW_OP_breg13:
3024 case DW_OP_breg14:
3025 case DW_OP_breg15:
3026 case DW_OP_breg16:
3027 case DW_OP_breg17:
3028 case DW_OP_breg18:
3029 case DW_OP_breg19:
3030 case DW_OP_breg20:
3031 case DW_OP_breg21:
3032 case DW_OP_breg22:
3033 case DW_OP_breg23:
3034 case DW_OP_breg24:
3035 case DW_OP_breg25:
3036 case DW_OP_breg26:
3037 case DW_OP_breg27:
3038 case DW_OP_breg28:
3039 case DW_OP_breg29:
3040 case DW_OP_breg30:
3041 case DW_OP_breg31:
3042 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3043 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3044 break;
3045 case DW_OP_bregx:
3046 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3047 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3048 break;
3049 case DW_OP_deref:
3050 cfa->indirect = 1;
3051 break;
3052 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3053 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3054 break;
3055 default:
3056 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented\n",
3057 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3058 }
3059 }
3060 }
3061 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3062 \f
3063 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3064 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3065
3066 /* .debug_str support. */
3067 static hashnode indirect_string_alloc PARAMS ((hash_table *));
3068 static int output_indirect_string PARAMS ((struct cpp_reader *,
3069 hashnode, const PTR));
3070
3071
3072 static void dwarf2out_init PARAMS ((const char *));
3073 static void dwarf2out_finish PARAMS ((const char *));
3074 static void dwarf2out_define PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
3075 static void dwarf2out_undef PARAMS ((unsigned int, const char *));
3076 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file PARAMS ((unsigned, const char *));
3077 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file PARAMS ((unsigned));
3078 static void dwarf2out_begin_block PARAMS ((unsigned, unsigned));
3079 static void dwarf2out_end_block PARAMS ((unsigned, unsigned));
3080 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block PARAMS ((tree));
3081 static void dwarf2out_global_decl PARAMS ((tree));
3082 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function PARAMS ((tree));
3083
3084 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3085
3086 struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3087 {
3088 dwarf2out_init,
3089 dwarf2out_finish,
3090 dwarf2out_define,
3091 dwarf2out_undef,
3092 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3093 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3094 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3095 dwarf2out_end_block,
3096 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3097 dwarf2out_source_line,
3098 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3099 debug_nothing_int, /* end_prologue */
3100 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3101 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
3102 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3103 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3104 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3105 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3106 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3107 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3108 something tries to reference them. */
3109 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3110 debug_nothing_rtx /* label */
3111 };
3112 \f
3113 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3114 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3115 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3116
3117 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3118 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3119 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3120 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3121
3122 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3123 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3124
3125 typedef long int dw_offset;
3126
3127 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3128
3129 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3130 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3131 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3132 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3133 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3134
3135 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3136 line number associated with the label generated for that
3137 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3138 the line number entry. */
3139
3140 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct
3141 {
3142 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3143 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3144 }
3145 dw_line_info_entry;
3146
3147 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3148 own sequence. */
3149 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct
3150 {
3151 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3152 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3153 unsigned long function;
3154 }
3155 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3156
3157 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3158 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3159 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3160
3161 typedef struct dw_attr_struct
3162 {
3163 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3164 dw_attr_ref dw_attr_next;
3165 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3166 }
3167 dw_attr_node;
3168
3169 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure */
3170
3171 typedef struct die_struct
3172 {
3173 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3174 char *die_symbol;
3175 dw_attr_ref die_attr;
3176 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3177 dw_die_ref die_child;
3178 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3179 dw_offset die_offset;
3180 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3181 int die_mark;
3182 }
3183 die_node;
3184
3185 /* The pubname structure */
3186
3187 typedef struct pubname_struct
3188 {
3189 dw_die_ref die;
3190 char *name;
3191 }
3192 pubname_entry;
3193
3194 struct dw_ranges_struct
3195 {
3196 int block_num;
3197 };
3198
3199 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3200 typedef struct limbo_die_struct
3201 {
3202 dw_die_ref die;
3203 tree created_for;
3204 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3205 }
3206 limbo_die_node;
3207
3208 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3209 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3210 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3211 #endif
3212
3213 /* Define a macro which returns non-zero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3214 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3215
3216 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3217 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3218 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3219 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3220 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3221 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3222
3223 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3224 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3225 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3226 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3227 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3228 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3229 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3230 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3231 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3232 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3233
3234 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3235 language, and compiler version. */
3236
3237 extern int flag_traditional;
3238
3239 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3240 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3241
3242 /* Fixed size portion of debugging line information prolog. */
3243 #define DWARF_LINE_PROLOG_HEADER_SIZE 5
3244
3245 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3246 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3247
3248 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3249 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3250 (DWARF_ROUND (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3251 - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
3252
3253 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3254 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3255 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3256 (DWARF_ROUND (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3257 - (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3258
3259 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3260 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3261 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3262 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3263 #else
3264 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3265 #endif
3266 #endif
3267
3268 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3269 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3270 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3271
3272 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3273 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3274
3275 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3276 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3277
3278 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3279 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3280 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3281 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3282 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3283
3284 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3285 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3286 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3287
3288 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3289 static dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3290
3291 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3292 static limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list = 0;
3293
3294 /* Structure used by lookup_filename to manage sets of filenames. */
3295 struct file_table
3296 {
3297 char **table;
3298 unsigned allocated;
3299 unsigned in_use;
3300 unsigned last_lookup_index;
3301 };
3302
3303 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the filename
3304 table. */
3305 #define FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3306
3307 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3308 static struct file_table file_table;
3309
3310 /* Local pointer to the name of the main input file. Initialized in
3311 dwarf2out_init. */
3312 static const char *primary_filename;
3313
3314 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to DIE's that describe
3315 declarations. The table is indexed by DECL_UID() which is a unique
3316 number identifying each decl. */
3317 static dw_die_ref *decl_die_table;
3318
3319 /* Number of elements currently allocated for the decl_die_table. */
3320 static unsigned decl_die_table_allocated;
3321
3322 /* Number of elements in decl_die_table currently in use. */
3323 static unsigned decl_die_table_in_use;
3324
3325 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3326 decl_die_table. */
3327 #define DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3328
3329 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
3330 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
3331 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
3332 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
3333 define type declaration DIE's. */
3334 varray_type decl_scope_table;
3335
3336 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3337 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3338 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3339 static dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3340
3341 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3342 static unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3343
3344 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3345 static unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3346
3347 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3348 abbrev_die_table. */
3349 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3350
3351 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3352 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3353 static dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3354
3355 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3356 static unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3357
3358 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3359 static unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3360
3361 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3362 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3363 static dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3364
3365 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3366 static unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3367
3368 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3369 static unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3370
3371 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3372 line_info_table. */
3373 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3374
3375 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3376 accessible names. */
3377 static pubname_ref pubname_table;
3378
3379 /* Number of elements currently allocated for pubname_table. */
3380 static unsigned pubname_table_allocated;
3381
3382 /* Number of elements in pubname_table currently in use. */
3383 static unsigned pubname_table_in_use;
3384
3385 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3386 pubname_table. */
3387 #define PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3388
3389 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3390 static dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3391
3392 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3393 static unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3394
3395 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3396 static unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3397
3398 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3399 arange_table. */
3400 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3401
3402 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3403 static dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3404
3405 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3406 static unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3407
3408 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3409 static unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3410
3411 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3412 ranges_table. */
3413 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3414
3415 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3416 static unsigned have_location_lists;
3417
3418 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
3419 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a VARRAY
3420 because we want to tell the garbage collector about it. */
3421 varray_type incomplete_types;
3422
3423 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
3424 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3425 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3426 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3427 #endif
3428
3429 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
3430 must be kept around forever. This is a GC root. */
3431 static varray_type used_rtx_varray;
3432
3433 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3434
3435 static int is_pseudo_reg PARAMS ((rtx));
3436 static tree type_main_variant PARAMS ((tree));
3437 static int is_tagged_type PARAMS ((tree));
3438 static const char *dwarf_tag_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3439 static const char *dwarf_attr_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3440 static const char *dwarf_form_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3441 #if 0
3442 static const char *dwarf_type_encoding_name PARAMS ((unsigned));
3443 #endif
3444 static tree decl_ultimate_origin PARAMS ((tree));
3445 static tree block_ultimate_origin PARAMS ((tree));
3446 static tree decl_class_context PARAMS ((tree));
3447 static void add_dwarf_attr PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref));
3448 static inline dw_val_class AT_class PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3449 static void add_AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3450 enum dwarf_attribute,
3451 unsigned));
3452 static inline unsigned AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3453 static void add_AT_int PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3454 enum dwarf_attribute, long));
3455 static inline long int AT_int PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3456 static void add_AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3457 enum dwarf_attribute,
3458 unsigned long));
3459 static inline unsigned long AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3460 static void add_AT_long_long PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3461 enum dwarf_attribute,
3462 unsigned long,
3463 unsigned long));
3464 static void add_AT_float PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3465 enum dwarf_attribute,
3466 unsigned, long *));
3467 static void add_AT_string PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3468 enum dwarf_attribute,
3469 const char *));
3470 static inline const char *AT_string PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3471 static int AT_string_form PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3472 static void add_AT_die_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3473 enum dwarf_attribute,
3474 dw_die_ref));
3475 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3476 static inline int AT_ref_external PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3477 static inline void set_AT_ref_external PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref, int));
3478 static void add_AT_fde_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3479 enum dwarf_attribute,
3480 unsigned));
3481 static void add_AT_loc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3482 enum dwarf_attribute,
3483 dw_loc_descr_ref));
3484 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3485 static void add_AT_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3486 enum dwarf_attribute,
3487 dw_loc_list_ref));
3488 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3489 static void add_AT_addr PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3490 enum dwarf_attribute,
3491 rtx));
3492 static inline rtx AT_addr PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3493 static void add_AT_lbl_id PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3494 enum dwarf_attribute,
3495 const char *));
3496 static void add_AT_lbl_offset PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3497 enum dwarf_attribute,
3498 const char *));
3499 static void add_AT_offset PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3500 enum dwarf_attribute,
3501 unsigned long));
3502 static void add_AT_range_list PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3503 enum dwarf_attribute,
3504 unsigned long));
3505 static inline const char *AT_lbl PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3506 static dw_attr_ref get_AT PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3507 enum dwarf_attribute));
3508 static const char *get_AT_low_pc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3509 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3510 static const char *get_AT_string PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3511 enum dwarf_attribute));
3512 static int get_AT_flag PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3513 enum dwarf_attribute));
3514 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3515 enum dwarf_attribute));
3516 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3517 enum dwarf_attribute));
3518 static int is_c_family PARAMS ((void));
3519 static int is_cxx PARAMS ((void));
3520 static int is_java PARAMS ((void));
3521 static int is_fortran PARAMS ((void));
3522 static void remove_AT PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3523 enum dwarf_attribute));
3524 static inline void free_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3525 static void remove_children PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3526 static void add_child_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
3527 static dw_die_ref new_die PARAMS ((enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref,
3528 tree));
3529 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die PARAMS ((tree));
3530 static void equate_type_number_to_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3531 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die PARAMS ((tree));
3532 static void equate_decl_number_to_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3533 static void print_spaces PARAMS ((FILE *));
3534 static void print_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, FILE *));
3535 static void print_dwarf_line_table PARAMS ((FILE *));
3536 static void reverse_die_lists PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3537 static void reverse_all_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3538 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
3539 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3540 static void loc_checksum PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref,
3541 struct md5_ctx *));
3542 static void attr_checksum PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref,
3543 struct md5_ctx *));
3544 static void die_checksum PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3545 struct md5_ctx *));
3546 static void compute_section_prefix PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3547 static int is_type_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3548 static int is_comdat_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3549 static int is_symbol_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3550 static void assign_symbol_names PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3551 static void break_out_includes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3552 static void add_sibling_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3553 static void build_abbrev_table PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3554 static void output_location_lists PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3555 static int constant_size PARAMS ((long unsigned));
3556 static unsigned long size_of_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3557 static void calc_die_sizes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3558 static void mark_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3559 static void unmark_dies PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3560 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames PARAMS ((void));
3561 static unsigned long size_of_aranges PARAMS ((void));
3562 static enum dwarf_form value_format PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3563 static void output_value_format PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
3564 static void output_abbrev_section PARAMS ((void));
3565 static void output_die_symbol PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3566 static void output_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3567 static void output_compilation_unit_header PARAMS ((void));
3568 static void output_comp_unit PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3569 static const char *dwarf2_name PARAMS ((tree, int));
3570 static void add_pubname PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3571 static void output_pubnames PARAMS ((void));
3572 static void add_arange PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3573 static void output_aranges PARAMS ((void));
3574 static unsigned int add_ranges PARAMS ((tree));
3575 static void output_ranges PARAMS ((void));
3576 static void output_line_info PARAMS ((void));
3577 static void output_file_names PARAMS ((void));
3578 static dw_die_ref base_type_die PARAMS ((tree));
3579 static tree root_type PARAMS ((tree));
3580 static int is_base_type PARAMS ((tree));
3581 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die PARAMS ((tree, int, int, dw_die_ref));
3582 static int type_is_enum PARAMS ((tree));
3583 static unsigned int reg_number PARAMS ((rtx));
3584 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx));
3585 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((HOST_WIDE_INT));
3586 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr PARAMS ((unsigned, long));
3587 static int is_based_loc PARAMS ((rtx));
3588 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx, enum machine_mode mode));
3589 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx, rtx));
3590 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor PARAMS ((rtx));
3591 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree PARAMS ((tree, int));
3592 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling PARAMS ((HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int));
3593 static tree field_type PARAMS ((tree));
3594 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
3595 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
3596 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits PARAMS ((tree));
3597 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset PARAMS ((tree));
3598 static void add_AT_location_description PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3599 enum dwarf_attribute, rtx));
3600 static void add_data_member_location_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3601 static void add_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, rtx));
3602 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location PARAMS ((tree));
3603 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3604 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3605 static void add_name_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, const char *));
3606 static void add_bound_info PARAMS ((dw_die_ref,
3607 enum dwarf_attribute, tree));
3608 static void add_subscript_info PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3609 static void add_byte_size_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3610 static void add_bit_offset_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3611 static void add_bit_size_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3612 static void add_prototyped_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3613 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3614 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3615 static void add_src_coords_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3616 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree));
3617 static void push_decl_scope PARAMS ((tree));
3618 static void pop_decl_scope PARAMS ((void));
3619 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3620 static inline int local_scope_p PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3621 static inline int class_scope_p PARAMS ((dw_die_ref));
3622 static void add_type_attribute PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, tree, int, int,
3623 dw_die_ref));
3624 static const char *type_tag PARAMS ((tree));
3625 static tree member_declared_type PARAMS ((tree));
3626 #if 0
3627 static const char *decl_start_label PARAMS ((tree));
3628 #endif
3629 static void gen_array_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3630 static void gen_set_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3631 #if 0
3632 static void gen_entry_point_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3633 #endif
3634 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3635 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3636 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3637 static void gen_enumeration_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3638 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3639 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3640 static void gen_formal_types_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3641 static void gen_subprogram_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3642 static void gen_variable_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3643 static void gen_label_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3644 static void gen_lexical_block_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3645 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3646 static void gen_field_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3647 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3648 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die PARAMS ((const char *));
3649 static void gen_string_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3650 static void gen_inheritance_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3651 static void gen_member_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3652 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3653 static void gen_subroutine_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3654 static void gen_typedef_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3655 static void gen_type_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3656 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3657 static void gen_block_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3658 static void decls_for_scope PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref, int));
3659 static int is_redundant_typedef PARAMS ((tree));
3660 static void gen_decl_die PARAMS ((tree, dw_die_ref));
3661 static unsigned lookup_filename PARAMS ((const char *));
3662 static void init_file_table PARAMS ((void));
3663 static void retry_incomplete_types PARAMS ((void));
3664 static void gen_type_die_for_member PARAMS ((tree, tree, dw_die_ref));
3665 static void splice_child_die PARAMS ((dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref));
3666 static int file_info_cmp PARAMS ((const void *, const void *));
3667 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_descr_ref,
3668 const char *, const char *,
3669 const char *, unsigned));
3670 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_list_ref *,
3671 dw_loc_descr_ref,
3672 const char *, const char *, const char *));
3673 static void output_loc_list PARAMS ((dw_loc_list_ref));
3674 static char *gen_internal_sym PARAMS ((const char *));
3675 static void mark_limbo_die_list PARAMS ((void *));
3676
3677 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3678 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3679 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3680 #endif
3681 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3682 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3683 #endif
3684 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3685 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3686 #endif
3687 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3688 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3689 #endif
3690 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3691 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3692 #endif
3693 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3694 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3695 #endif
3696 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3697 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
3698 #endif
3699 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3700 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3701 #endif
3702 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3703 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3704 #endif
3705
3706 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3707 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3708 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3709 #endif
3710
3711 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3712 #ifdef HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE
3713 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3714 (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1)
3715 #else
3716 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS SECTION_DEBUG
3717 #endif
3718
3719 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3720 the section names themselves. */
3721
3722 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3723 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3724 #endif
3725 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3726 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3727 #endif
3728 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3729 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3730 #endif
3731 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3732 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3733 #endif
3734 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3735 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3736 #endif
3737 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3738 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3739 #endif
3740 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3741 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3742 #endif
3743
3744 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3745 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3746 options is used and DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3747 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3748 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3749
3750 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3751 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3752 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3753 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3754 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3755 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3756 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3757 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3758
3759 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3760 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3761 #endif
3762 #ifndef DATA_END_LABEL
3763 #define DATA_END_LABEL "Ledata"
3764 #endif
3765 #ifndef BSS_END_LABEL
3766 #define BSS_END_LABEL "Lebss"
3767 #endif
3768 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3769 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3770 #endif
3771 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3772 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3773 #endif
3774 #ifndef BODY_BEGIN_LABEL
3775 #define BODY_BEGIN_LABEL "Lbb"
3776 #endif
3777 #ifndef BODY_END_LABEL
3778 #define BODY_END_LABEL "Lbe"
3779 #endif
3780 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3781 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3782 #endif
3783 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
3784 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
3785 #endif
3786 \f
3787 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3788 called to "demangle" any name before it it put into a DIE. */
3789
3790 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) PARAMS ((const char *));
3791
3792 void
3793 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (func)
3794 const char *(*func) PARAMS ((const char *));
3795 {
3796 demangle_name_func = func;
3797 }
3798
3799 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3800
3801 static inline int
3802 is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
3803 rtx rtl;
3804 {
3805 return ((GET_CODE (rtl) == REG && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3806 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3807 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3808 }
3809
3810 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3811 removed. */
3812
3813 static inline tree
3814 type_main_variant (type)
3815 tree type;
3816 {
3817 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3818
3819 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3820 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3821 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3822 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3823 here. */
3824 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3825 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3826 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3827
3828 return type;
3829 }
3830
3831 /* Return non-zero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3832
3833 static inline int
3834 is_tagged_type (type)
3835 tree type;
3836 {
3837 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3838
3839 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3840 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3841 }
3842
3843 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
3844
3845 static const char *
3846 dwarf_tag_name (tag)
3847 unsigned tag;
3848 {
3849 switch (tag)
3850 {
3851 case DW_TAG_padding:
3852 return "DW_TAG_padding";
3853 case DW_TAG_array_type:
3854 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
3855 case DW_TAG_class_type:
3856 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
3857 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
3858 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
3859 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
3860 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
3861 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
3862 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
3863 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
3864 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
3865 case DW_TAG_label:
3866 return "DW_TAG_label";
3867 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
3868 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
3869 case DW_TAG_member:
3870 return "DW_TAG_member";
3871 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
3872 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
3873 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
3874 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
3875 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
3876 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
3877 case DW_TAG_string_type:
3878 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
3879 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
3880 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
3881 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
3882 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
3883 case DW_TAG_typedef:
3884 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
3885 case DW_TAG_union_type:
3886 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
3887 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
3888 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
3889 case DW_TAG_variant:
3890 return "DW_TAG_variant";
3891 case DW_TAG_common_block:
3892 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
3893 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
3894 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
3895 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
3896 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
3897 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
3898 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
3899 case DW_TAG_module:
3900 return "DW_TAG_module";
3901 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
3902 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
3903 case DW_TAG_set_type:
3904 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
3905 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
3906 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
3907 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
3908 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
3909 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
3910 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
3911 case DW_TAG_base_type:
3912 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
3913 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
3914 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
3915 case DW_TAG_const_type:
3916 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
3917 case DW_TAG_constant:
3918 return "DW_TAG_constant";
3919 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
3920 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
3921 case DW_TAG_file_type:
3922 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
3923 case DW_TAG_friend:
3924 return "DW_TAG_friend";
3925 case DW_TAG_namelist:
3926 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
3927 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
3928 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
3929 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
3930 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
3931 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
3932 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
3933 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
3934 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
3935 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
3936 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
3937 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
3938 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
3939 case DW_TAG_try_block:
3940 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
3941 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
3942 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
3943 case DW_TAG_variable:
3944 return "DW_TAG_variable";
3945 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
3946 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
3947 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
3948 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
3949 case DW_TAG_format_label:
3950 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
3951 case DW_TAG_function_template:
3952 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
3953 case DW_TAG_class_template:
3954 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
3955 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
3956 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
3957 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
3958 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
3959 default:
3960 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
3961 }
3962 }
3963
3964 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
3965
3966 static const char *
3967 dwarf_attr_name (attr)
3968 unsigned attr;
3969 {
3970 switch (attr)
3971 {
3972 case DW_AT_sibling:
3973 return "DW_AT_sibling";
3974 case DW_AT_location:
3975 return "DW_AT_location";
3976 case DW_AT_name:
3977 return "DW_AT_name";
3978 case DW_AT_ordering:
3979 return "DW_AT_ordering";
3980 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
3981 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
3982 case DW_AT_byte_size:
3983 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
3984 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
3985 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
3986 case DW_AT_bit_size:
3987 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
3988 case DW_AT_element_list:
3989 return "DW_AT_element_list";
3990 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
3991 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
3992 case DW_AT_low_pc:
3993 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
3994 case DW_AT_high_pc:
3995 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
3996 case DW_AT_language:
3997 return "DW_AT_language";
3998 case DW_AT_member:
3999 return "DW_AT_member";
4000 case DW_AT_discr:
4001 return "DW_AT_discr";
4002 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4003 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4004 case DW_AT_visibility:
4005 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4006 case DW_AT_import:
4007 return "DW_AT_import";
4008 case DW_AT_string_length:
4009 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4010 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4011 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4012 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4013 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4014 case DW_AT_const_value:
4015 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4016 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4017 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4018 case DW_AT_default_value:
4019 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4020 case DW_AT_inline:
4021 return "DW_AT_inline";
4022 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4023 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4024 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4025 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4026 case DW_AT_producer:
4027 return "DW_AT_producer";
4028 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4029 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4030 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4031 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4032 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4033 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4034 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4035 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4036 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4037 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4038 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4039 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4040 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4041 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4042 case DW_AT_address_class:
4043 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4044 case DW_AT_artificial:
4045 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4046 case DW_AT_base_types:
4047 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4048 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4049 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4050 case DW_AT_count:
4051 return "DW_AT_count";
4052 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4053 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4054 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4055 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4056 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4057 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4058 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4059 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4060 case DW_AT_declaration:
4061 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4062 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4063 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4064 case DW_AT_encoding:
4065 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4066 case DW_AT_external:
4067 return "DW_AT_external";
4068 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4069 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4070 case DW_AT_friend:
4071 return "DW_AT_friend";
4072 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4073 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4074 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4075 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4076 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4077 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4078 case DW_AT_priority:
4079 return "DW_AT_priority";
4080 case DW_AT_segment:
4081 return "DW_AT_segment";
4082 case DW_AT_specification:
4083 return "DW_AT_specification";
4084 case DW_AT_static_link:
4085 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4086 case DW_AT_type:
4087 return "DW_AT_type";
4088 case DW_AT_use_location:
4089 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4090 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4091 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4092 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4093 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4094 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4095 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4096
4097 case DW_AT_allocated:
4098 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4099 case DW_AT_associated:
4100 return "DW_AT_associated";
4101 case DW_AT_data_location:
4102 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4103 case DW_AT_stride:
4104 return "DW_AT_stride";
4105 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4106 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4107 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4108 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4109 case DW_AT_extension:
4110 return "DW_AT_extension";
4111 case DW_AT_ranges:
4112 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4113 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4114 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4115 case DW_AT_call_column:
4116 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4117 case DW_AT_call_file:
4118 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4119 case DW_AT_call_line:
4120 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4121
4122 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4123 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4124 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4125 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4126 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4127 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4128 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4129 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4130 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4131 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4132 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4133 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4134 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4135 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4136 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4137 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4138 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4139 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4140 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4141 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4142 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4143 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4144
4145 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4146 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4147 case DW_AT_src_info:
4148 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4149 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4150 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4151 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4152 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4153 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4154 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4155 case DW_AT_body_end:
4156 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4157 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4158 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4159
4160 default:
4161 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4162 }
4163 }
4164
4165 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4166
4167 static const char *
4168 dwarf_form_name (form)
4169 unsigned form;
4170 {
4171 switch (form)
4172 {
4173 case DW_FORM_addr:
4174 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4175 case DW_FORM_block2:
4176 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4177 case DW_FORM_block4:
4178 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4179 case DW_FORM_data2:
4180 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4181 case DW_FORM_data4:
4182 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4183 case DW_FORM_data8:
4184 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4185 case DW_FORM_string:
4186 return "DW_FORM_string";
4187 case DW_FORM_block:
4188 return "DW_FORM_block";
4189 case DW_FORM_block1:
4190 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4191 case DW_FORM_data1:
4192 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4193 case DW_FORM_flag:
4194 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4195 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4196 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4197 case DW_FORM_strp:
4198 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4199 case DW_FORM_udata:
4200 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4201 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4202 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4203 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4204 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4205 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4206 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4207 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4208 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4209 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4210 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4211 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4212 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4213 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4214 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4215 default:
4216 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4217 }
4218 }
4219
4220 /* Convert a DWARF type code into its string name. */
4221
4222 #if 0
4223 static const char *
4224 dwarf_type_encoding_name (enc)
4225 unsigned enc;
4226 {
4227 switch (enc)
4228 {
4229 case DW_ATE_address:
4230 return "DW_ATE_address";
4231 case DW_ATE_boolean:
4232 return "DW_ATE_boolean";
4233 case DW_ATE_complex_float:
4234 return "DW_ATE_complex_float";
4235 case DW_ATE_float:
4236 return "DW_ATE_float";
4237 case DW_ATE_signed:
4238 return "DW_ATE_signed";
4239 case DW_ATE_signed_char:
4240 return "DW_ATE_signed_char";
4241 case DW_ATE_unsigned:
4242 return "DW_ATE_unsigned";
4243 case DW_ATE_unsigned_char:
4244 return "DW_ATE_unsigned_char";
4245 default:
4246 return "DW_ATE_<unknown>";
4247 }
4248 }
4249 #endif
4250 \f
4251 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4252 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4253 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4254 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4255 given block. */
4256
4257 static tree
4258 decl_ultimate_origin (decl)
4259 tree decl;
4260 {
4261 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4262 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4263 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4264 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4265 return NULL_TREE;
4266
4267 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
4268 if (DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)))
4269 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4270 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4271 abort ();
4272 #endif
4273
4274 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4275 }
4276
4277 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4278 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4279 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4280 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4281 given block. */
4282
4283 static tree
4284 block_ultimate_origin (block)
4285 tree block;
4286 {
4287 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4288
4289 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4290 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4291 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4292 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4293 return NULL_TREE;
4294
4295 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4296 return NULL_TREE;
4297 else
4298 {
4299 tree ret_val;
4300 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4301
4302 do
4303 {
4304 ret_val = lookahead;
4305 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4306 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4307 }
4308 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4309
4310 return ret_val;
4311 }
4312 }
4313
4314 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4315 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4316 parameter. */
4317
4318 static tree
4319 decl_class_context (decl)
4320 tree decl;
4321 {
4322 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4323
4324 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4325 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4326 else
4327 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4328 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4329
4330 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4331 context = NULL_TREE;
4332
4333 return context;
4334 }
4335 \f
4336 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. We build the lists up in reverse
4337 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
4338
4339 static inline void
4340 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr)
4341 dw_die_ref die;
4342 dw_attr_ref attr;
4343 {
4344 if (die != NULL && attr != NULL)
4345 {
4346 attr->dw_attr_next = die->die_attr;
4347 die->die_attr = attr;
4348 }
4349 }
4350
4351 static inline dw_val_class
4352 AT_class (a)
4353 dw_attr_ref a;
4354 {
4355 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4356 }
4357
4358 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4359
4360 static inline void
4361 add_AT_flag (die, attr_kind, flag)
4362 dw_die_ref die;
4363 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4364 unsigned flag;
4365 {
4366 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4367
4368 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4369 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4370 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4371 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4372 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4373 }
4374
4375 static inline unsigned
4376 AT_flag (a)
4377 dw_attr_ref a;
4378 {
4379 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag)
4380 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4381
4382 abort ();
4383 }
4384
4385 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4386
4387 static inline void
4388 add_AT_int (die, attr_kind, int_val)
4389 dw_die_ref die;
4390 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4391 long int int_val;
4392 {
4393 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4394
4395 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4396 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4397 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4398 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4399 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4400 }
4401
4402 static inline long int
4403 AT_int (a)
4404 dw_attr_ref a;
4405 {
4406 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const)
4407 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4408
4409 abort ();
4410 }
4411
4412 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4413
4414 static inline void
4415 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr_kind, unsigned_val)
4416 dw_die_ref die;
4417 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4418 unsigned long unsigned_val;
4419 {
4420 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4421
4422 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4423 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4424 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4425 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4426 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4427 }
4428
4429 static inline unsigned long
4430 AT_unsigned (a)
4431 dw_attr_ref a;
4432 {
4433 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
4434 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4435
4436 abort ();
4437 }
4438
4439 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4440
4441 static inline void
4442 add_AT_long_long (die, attr_kind, val_hi, val_low)
4443 dw_die_ref die;
4444 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4445 unsigned long val_hi;
4446 unsigned long val_low;
4447 {
4448 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4449
4450 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4451 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4452 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4453 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4454 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4455 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4456 }
4457
4458 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4459
4460 static inline void
4461 add_AT_float (die, attr_kind, length, array)
4462 dw_die_ref die;
4463 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4464 unsigned length;
4465 long *array;
4466 {
4467 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4468
4469 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4470 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4471 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_float;
4472 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length = length;
4473 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array = array;
4474 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4475 }
4476
4477 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4478
4479 static inline void
4480 add_AT_string (die, attr_kind, str)
4481 dw_die_ref die;
4482 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4483 const char *str;
4484 {
4485 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4486 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4487
4488 if (! debug_str_hash)
4489 {
4490 debug_str_hash = ht_create (10);
4491 debug_str_hash->alloc_node = indirect_string_alloc;
4492 }
4493
4494 node = (struct indirect_string_node *)
4495 ht_lookup (debug_str_hash, (const unsigned char *) str,
4496 strlen (str), HT_ALLOC);
4497 node->refcount++;
4498
4499 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4500 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4501 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4502 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4503 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4504 }
4505
4506 static inline const char *
4507 AT_string (a)
4508 dw_attr_ref a;
4509 {
4510 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4511 return (const char *) HT_STR (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->id);
4512
4513 abort ();
4514 }
4515
4516 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4517 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4518
4519 static int
4520 AT_string_form (a)
4521 dw_attr_ref a;
4522 {
4523 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4524 {
4525 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4526 unsigned int len;
4527 extern int const_labelno;
4528 char label[32];
4529
4530 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
4531 if (node->form)
4532 return node->form;
4533
4534 len = HT_LEN (&node->id) + 1;
4535
4536 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4537 always better to put it inline. */
4538 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4539 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4540
4541 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4542 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4543 single module. */
4544 if ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4545 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
4546 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4547
4548 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LC", const_labelno);
4549 ++const_labelno;
4550 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4551
4552 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4553 }
4554
4555 abort ();
4556 }
4557
4558 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4559
4560 static inline void
4561 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr_kind, targ_die)
4562 dw_die_ref die;
4563 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4564 dw_die_ref targ_die;
4565 {
4566 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4567
4568 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4569 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4570 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4571 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4572 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4573 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4574 }
4575
4576 static inline dw_die_ref
4577 AT_ref (a)
4578 dw_attr_ref a;
4579 {
4580 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4581 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4582
4583 abort ();
4584 }
4585
4586 static inline int
4587 AT_ref_external (a)
4588 dw_attr_ref a;
4589 {
4590 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4591 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4592
4593 return 0;
4594 }
4595
4596 static inline void
4597 set_AT_ref_external (a, i)
4598 dw_attr_ref a;
4599 int i;
4600 {
4601 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4602 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4603 else
4604 abort ();
4605 }
4606
4607 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4608
4609 static inline void
4610 add_AT_fde_ref (die, attr_kind, targ_fde)
4611 dw_die_ref die;
4612 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4613 unsigned targ_fde;
4614 {
4615 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4616
4617 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4618 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4619 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4620 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4621 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4622 }
4623
4624 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4625
4626 static inline void
4627 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, loc)
4628 dw_die_ref die;
4629 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4630 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4631 {
4632 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4633
4634 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4635 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4636 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4637 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4638 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4639 }
4640
4641 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4642 AT_loc (a)
4643 dw_attr_ref a;
4644 {
4645 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc)
4646 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4647
4648 abort ();
4649 }
4650
4651 static inline void
4652 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, loc_list)
4653 dw_die_ref die;
4654 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4655 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
4656 {
4657 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4658
4659 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4660 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4661 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4662 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4663 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4664 have_location_lists = 1;
4665 }
4666
4667 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4668 AT_loc_list (a)
4669 dw_attr_ref a;
4670 {
4671 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
4672 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4673
4674 abort ();
4675 }
4676
4677 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
4678
4679 static inline void
4680 add_AT_addr (die, attr_kind, addr)
4681 dw_die_ref die;
4682 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4683 rtx addr;
4684 {
4685 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4686
4687 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4688 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4689 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4690 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4691 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4692 }
4693
4694 static inline rtx
4695 AT_addr (a)
4696 dw_attr_ref a;
4697 {
4698 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr)
4699 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4700
4701 abort ();
4702 }
4703
4704 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4705
4706 static inline void
4707 add_AT_lbl_id (die, attr_kind, lbl_id)
4708 dw_die_ref die;
4709 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4710 const char *lbl_id;
4711 {
4712 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4713
4714 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4715 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4716 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4717 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4718 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4719 }
4720
4721 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4722
4723 static inline void
4724 add_AT_lbl_offset (die, attr_kind, label)
4725 dw_die_ref die;
4726 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4727 const char *label;
4728 {
4729 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4730
4731 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4732 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4733 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_offset;
4734 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4735 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4736 }
4737
4738 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4739
4740 static inline void
4741 add_AT_offset (die, attr_kind, offset)
4742 dw_die_ref die;
4743 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4744 unsigned long offset;
4745 {
4746 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4747
4748 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4749 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4750 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4751 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4752 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4753 }
4754
4755 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
4756
4757 static void
4758 add_AT_range_list (die, attr_kind, offset)
4759 dw_die_ref die;
4760 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4761 unsigned long offset;
4762 {
4763 dw_attr_ref attr = (dw_attr_ref) xmalloc (sizeof (dw_attr_node));
4764
4765 attr->dw_attr_next = NULL;
4766 attr->dw_attr = attr_kind;
4767 attr->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4768 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4769 add_dwarf_attr (die, attr);
4770 }
4771
4772 static inline const char *
4773 AT_lbl (a)
4774 dw_attr_ref a;
4775 {
4776 if (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4777 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_offset))
4778 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4779
4780 abort ();
4781 }
4782
4783 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4784
4785 static inline dw_attr_ref
4786 get_AT (die, attr_kind)
4787 dw_die_ref die;
4788 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4789 {
4790 dw_attr_ref a;
4791 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4792
4793 if (die != NULL)
4794 {
4795 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
4796 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4797 return a;
4798 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
4799 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
4800 spec = AT_ref (a);
4801
4802 if (spec)
4803 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
4804 }
4805
4806 return NULL;
4807 }
4808
4809 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4810 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4811 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4812
4813 static inline const char *
4814 get_AT_low_pc (die)
4815 dw_die_ref die;
4816 {
4817 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
4818
4819 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4820 }
4821
4822 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4823 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4824 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4825
4826 static inline const char *
4827 get_AT_hi_pc (die)
4828 dw_die_ref die;
4829 {
4830 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
4831
4832 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4833 }
4834
4835 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
4836 NULL if it is not present. */
4837
4838 static inline const char *
4839 get_AT_string (die, attr_kind)
4840 dw_die_ref die;
4841 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4842 {
4843 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4844
4845 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
4846 }
4847
4848 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
4849 if it is not present. */
4850
4851 static inline int
4852 get_AT_flag (die, attr_kind)
4853 dw_die_ref die;
4854 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4855 {
4856 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4857
4858 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
4859 }
4860
4861 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
4862 if it is not present. */
4863
4864 static inline unsigned
4865 get_AT_unsigned (die, attr_kind)
4866 dw_die_ref die;
4867 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4868 {
4869 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4870
4871 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
4872 }
4873
4874 static inline dw_die_ref
4875 get_AT_ref (die, attr_kind)
4876 dw_die_ref die;
4877 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4878 {
4879 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4880
4881 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
4882 }
4883
4884 static inline int
4885 is_c_family ()
4886 {
4887 unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4888
4889 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89
4890 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
4891 }
4892
4893 static inline int
4894 is_cxx ()
4895 {
4896 return (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
4897 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus);
4898 }
4899
4900 static inline int
4901 is_fortran ()
4902 {
4903 unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4904
4905 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90);
4906 }
4907
4908 static inline int
4909 is_java ()
4910 {
4911 unsigned lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
4912
4913 return (lang == DW_LANG_Java);
4914 }
4915
4916 /* Free up the memory used by A. */
4917
4918 static inline void free_AT PARAMS ((dw_attr_ref));
4919 static inline void
4920 free_AT (a)
4921 dw_attr_ref a;
4922 {
4923 switch (AT_class (a))
4924 {
4925 case dw_val_class_str:
4926 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
4927 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
4928 break;
4929
4930 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
4931 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
4932 free (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id);
4933 break;
4934
4935 case dw_val_class_float:
4936 free (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array);
4937 break;
4938
4939 default:
4940 break;
4941 }
4942
4943 free (a);
4944 }
4945
4946 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
4947
4948 static void
4949 remove_AT (die, attr_kind)
4950 dw_die_ref die;
4951 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
4952 {
4953 dw_attr_ref *p;
4954 dw_attr_ref removed = NULL;
4955
4956 if (die != NULL)
4957 {
4958 for (p = &(die->die_attr); *p; p = &((*p)->dw_attr_next))
4959 if ((*p)->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4960 {
4961 removed = *p;
4962 *p = (*p)->dw_attr_next;
4963 break;
4964 }
4965
4966 if (removed != 0)
4967 free_AT (removed);
4968 }
4969 }
4970
4971 /* Free up the memory used by DIE. */
4972
4973 static inline void
4974 free_die (die)
4975 dw_die_ref die;
4976 {
4977 remove_children (die);
4978 free (die);
4979 }
4980
4981 /* Discard the children of this DIE. */
4982
4983 static void
4984 remove_children (die)
4985 dw_die_ref die;
4986 {
4987 dw_die_ref child_die = die->die_child;
4988
4989 die->die_child = NULL;
4990
4991 while (child_die != NULL)
4992 {
4993 dw_die_ref tmp_die = child_die;
4994 dw_attr_ref a;
4995
4996 child_die = child_die->die_sib;
4997
4998 for (a = tmp_die->die_attr; a != NULL;)
4999 {
5000 dw_attr_ref tmp_a = a;
5001
5002 a = a->dw_attr_next;
5003 free_AT (tmp_a);
5004 }
5005
5006 free_die (tmp_die);
5007 }
5008 }
5009
5010 /* Add a child DIE below its parent. We build the lists up in reverse
5011 addition order, and correct that in reverse_all_dies. */
5012
5013 static inline void
5014 add_child_die (die, child_die)
5015 dw_die_ref die;
5016 dw_die_ref child_die;
5017 {
5018 if (die != NULL && child_die != NULL)
5019 {
5020 if (die == child_die)
5021 abort ();
5022
5023 child_die->die_parent = die;
5024 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child;
5025 die->die_child = child_die;
5026 }
5027 }
5028
5029 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5030 is the specification, to the front of PARENT's list of children. */
5031
5032 static void
5033 splice_child_die (parent, child)
5034 dw_die_ref parent, child;
5035 {
5036 dw_die_ref *p;
5037
5038 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5039 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5040 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5041 {
5042 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5043
5044 if (tmp)
5045 child = tmp;
5046 }
5047
5048 if (child->die_parent != parent
5049 && child->die_parent != get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification))
5050 abort ();
5051
5052 for (p = &(child->die_parent->die_child); *p; p = &((*p)->die_sib))
5053 if (*p == child)
5054 {
5055 *p = child->die_sib;
5056 break;
5057 }
5058
5059 child->die_sib = parent->die_child;
5060 parent->die_child = child;
5061 }
5062
5063 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5064
5065 static inline dw_die_ref
5066 new_die (tag_value, parent_die, t)
5067 enum dwarf_tag tag_value;
5068 dw_die_ref parent_die;
5069 tree t;
5070 {
5071 dw_die_ref die = (dw_die_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (die_node));
5072
5073 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5074
5075 if (parent_die != NULL)
5076 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5077 else
5078 {
5079 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5080
5081 limbo_node = (limbo_die_node *) xmalloc (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5082 limbo_node->die = die;
5083 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5084 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5085 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5086 }
5087
5088 return die;
5089 }
5090
5091 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5092
5093 static inline dw_die_ref
5094 lookup_type_die (type)
5095 tree type;
5096 {
5097 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
5098 type = TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type);
5099
5100 return (dw_die_ref) TYPE_SYMTAB_POINTER (type);
5101 }
5102
5103 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5104
5105 static inline void
5106 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die)
5107 tree type;
5108 dw_die_ref type_die;
5109 {
5110 TYPE_SYMTAB_POINTER (type) = (char *) type_die;
5111 }
5112
5113 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5114
5115 static inline dw_die_ref
5116 lookup_decl_die (decl)
5117 tree decl;
5118 {
5119 unsigned decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5120
5121 return (decl_id < decl_die_table_in_use ? decl_die_table[decl_id] : NULL);
5122 }
5123
5124 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5125
5126 static void
5127 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die)
5128 tree decl;
5129 dw_die_ref decl_die;
5130 {
5131 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5132 unsigned int num_allocated;
5133
5134 if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_allocated)
5135 {
5136 num_allocated
5137 = ((decl_id + 1 + DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT - 1)
5138 / DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT)
5139 * DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
5140
5141 decl_die_table
5142 = (dw_die_ref *) xrealloc (decl_die_table,
5143 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * num_allocated);
5144
5145 memset ((char *) &decl_die_table[decl_die_table_allocated], 0,
5146 (num_allocated - decl_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
5147 decl_die_table_allocated = num_allocated;
5148 }
5149
5150 if (decl_id >= decl_die_table_in_use)
5151 decl_die_table_in_use = (decl_id + 1);
5152
5153 decl_die_table[decl_id] = decl_die;
5154 }
5155 \f
5156 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5157 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5158 the DIE internal representation. */
5159 static int print_indent;
5160
5161 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5162
5163 static inline void
5164 print_spaces (outfile)
5165 FILE *outfile;
5166 {
5167 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5168 }
5169
5170 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5171 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5172
5173 static void
5174 print_die (die, outfile)
5175 dw_die_ref die;
5176 FILE *outfile;
5177 {
5178 dw_attr_ref a;
5179 dw_die_ref c;
5180
5181 print_spaces (outfile);
5182 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5183 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5184 print_spaces (outfile);
5185 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5186 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5187
5188 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5189 {
5190 print_spaces (outfile);
5191 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5192
5193 switch (AT_class (a))
5194 {
5195 case dw_val_class_addr:
5196 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5197 break;
5198 case dw_val_class_offset:
5199 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5200 break;
5201 case dw_val_class_loc:
5202 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5203 break;
5204 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5205 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5206 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5207 break;
5208 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5209 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5210 break;
5211 case dw_val_class_const:
5212 fprintf (outfile, "%ld", AT_int (a));
5213 break;
5214 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5215 fprintf (outfile, "%lu", AT_unsigned (a));
5216 break;
5217 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5218 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5219 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5220 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5221 break;
5222 case dw_val_class_float:
5223 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point constant");
5224 break;
5225 case dw_val_class_flag:
5226 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5227 break;
5228 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5229 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5230 {
5231 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5232 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5233 else
5234 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5235 }
5236 else
5237 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5238 break;
5239 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5240 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5241 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5242 break;
5243 case dw_val_class_str:
5244 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5245 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5246 else
5247 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5248 break;
5249 default:
5250 break;
5251 }
5252
5253 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5254 }
5255
5256 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5257 {
5258 print_indent += 4;
5259 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5260 print_die (c, outfile);
5261
5262 print_indent -= 4;
5263 }
5264 if (print_indent == 0)
5265 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5266 }
5267
5268 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5269 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5270
5271 static void
5272 print_dwarf_line_table (outfile)
5273 FILE *outfile;
5274 {
5275 unsigned i;
5276 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5277
5278 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5279 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5280 {
5281 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5282 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: ", i);
5283 fprintf (outfile, "%-20s", file_table.table[line_info->dw_file_num]);
5284 fprintf (outfile, "%6ld", line_info->dw_line_num);
5285 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5286 }
5287
5288 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5289 }
5290
5291 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5292
5293 void
5294 debug_dwarf_die (die)
5295 dw_die_ref die;
5296 {
5297 print_die (die, stderr);
5298 }
5299
5300 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5301 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5302
5303 void
5304 debug_dwarf ()
5305 {
5306 print_indent = 0;
5307 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5308 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5309 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5310 }
5311 \f
5312 /* We build up the lists of children and attributes by pushing new ones
5313 onto the beginning of the list. Reverse the lists for DIE so that
5314 they are in order of addition. */
5315
5316 static void
5317 reverse_die_lists (die)
5318 dw_die_ref die;
5319 {
5320 dw_die_ref c, cp, cn;
5321 dw_attr_ref a, ap, an;
5322
5323 for (a = die->die_attr, ap = 0; a; a = an)
5324 {
5325 an = a->dw_attr_next;
5326 a->dw_attr_next = ap;
5327 ap = a;
5328 }
5329
5330 die->die_attr = ap;
5331
5332 for (c = die->die_child, cp = 0; c; c = cn)
5333 {
5334 cn = c->die_sib;
5335 c->die_sib = cp;
5336 cp = c;
5337 }
5338
5339 die->die_child = cp;
5340 }
5341
5342 /* reverse_die_lists only reverses the single die you pass it. Since we used to
5343 reverse all dies in add_sibling_attributes, which runs through all the dies,
5344 it would reverse all the dies. Now, however, since we don't call
5345 reverse_die_lists in add_sibling_attributes, we need a routine to
5346 recursively reverse all the dies. This is that routine. */
5347
5348 static void
5349 reverse_all_dies (die)
5350 dw_die_ref die;
5351 {
5352 dw_die_ref c;
5353
5354 reverse_die_lists (die);
5355
5356 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5357 reverse_all_dies (c);
5358 }
5359
5360 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5361 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5362 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5363
5364 static dw_die_ref
5365 push_new_compile_unit (old_unit, bincl_die)
5366 dw_die_ref old_unit, bincl_die;
5367 {
5368 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5369 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5370
5371 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5372 return new_unit;
5373 }
5374
5375 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5376
5377 static dw_die_ref
5378 pop_compile_unit (old_unit)
5379 dw_die_ref old_unit;
5380 {
5381 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5382
5383 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5384 return new_unit;
5385 }
5386
5387 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5388 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5389
5390 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5391
5392 static inline void
5393 loc_checksum (loc, ctx)
5394 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5395 struct md5_ctx *ctx;
5396 {
5397 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5398 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5399 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5400 }
5401
5402 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5403
5404 static void
5405 attr_checksum (at, ctx)
5406 dw_attr_ref at;
5407 struct md5_ctx *ctx;
5408 {
5409 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5410 rtx r;
5411
5412 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5413
5414 /* We don't care about differences in file numbering. */
5415 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_file
5416 /* Or that this was compiled with a different compiler snapshot; if
5417 the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5418 || at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5419 return;
5420
5421 switch (AT_class (at))
5422 {
5423 case dw_val_class_const:
5424 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5425 break;
5426 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5427 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5428 break;
5429 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5430 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5431 break;
5432 case dw_val_class_float:
5433 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_float);
5434 break;
5435 case dw_val_class_flag:
5436 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5437 break;
5438 case dw_val_class_str:
5439 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5440 break;
5441
5442 case dw_val_class_addr:
5443 r = AT_addr (at);
5444 switch (GET_CODE (r))
5445 {
5446 case SYMBOL_REF:
5447 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5448 break;
5449
5450 default:
5451 abort ();
5452 }
5453 break;
5454
5455 case dw_val_class_offset:
5456 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5457 break;
5458
5459 case dw_val_class_loc:
5460 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5461 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5462 break;
5463
5464 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5465 if (AT_ref (at)->die_offset)
5466 CHECKSUM (AT_ref (at)->die_offset);
5467 /* FIXME else use target die name or something. */
5468
5469 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5470 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5471 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5472 break;
5473
5474 default:
5475 break;
5476 }
5477 }
5478
5479 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
5480
5481 static void
5482 die_checksum (die, ctx)
5483 dw_die_ref die;
5484 struct md5_ctx *ctx;
5485 {
5486 dw_die_ref c;
5487 dw_attr_ref a;
5488
5489 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
5490
5491 for (a = die->die_attr; a; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5492 attr_checksum (a, ctx);
5493
5494 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5495 die_checksum (c, ctx);
5496 }
5497
5498 #undef CHECKSUM
5499 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
5500
5501 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
5502 info section. */
5503 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
5504
5505 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
5506 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
5507
5508 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
5509 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
5510
5511 static void
5512 compute_section_prefix (unit_die)
5513 dw_die_ref unit_die;
5514 {
5515 const char *base = lbasename (get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name));
5516 char *name = (char *) alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
5517 char *p;
5518 int i;
5519 unsigned char checksum[16];
5520 struct md5_ctx ctx;
5521
5522 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
5523 the name filename of the unit. */
5524
5525 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
5526 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx);
5527 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
5528
5529 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
5530 clean_symbol_name (name);
5531
5532 p = name + strlen (name);
5533 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
5534 {
5535 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
5536 p += 2;
5537 }
5538
5539 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
5540 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
5541 }
5542
5543 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
5544
5545 static int
5546 is_type_die (die)
5547 dw_die_ref die;
5548 {
5549 switch (die->die_tag)
5550 {
5551 case DW_TAG_array_type:
5552 case DW_TAG_class_type:
5553 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
5554 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
5555 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
5556 case DW_TAG_string_type:
5557 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
5558 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
5559 case DW_TAG_union_type:
5560 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
5561 case DW_TAG_set_type:
5562 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
5563 case DW_TAG_base_type:
5564 case DW_TAG_const_type:
5565 case DW_TAG_file_type:
5566 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
5567 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
5568 return 1;
5569 default:
5570 return 0;
5571 }
5572 }
5573
5574 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
5575 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
5576 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
5577 compilations (functions). */
5578
5579 static int
5580 is_comdat_die (c)
5581 dw_die_ref c;
5582 {
5583 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
5584 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
5585 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
5586 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
5587
5588 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
5589 return 0;
5590
5591 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
5592 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
5593 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
5594 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
5595 {
5596 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
5597
5598 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
5599 }
5600
5601 return is_type_die (c);
5602 }
5603
5604 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
5605 compilation unit. */
5606
5607 static int
5608 is_symbol_die (c)
5609 dw_die_ref c;
5610 {
5611 return (is_type_die (c)
5612 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
5613 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification)));
5614 }
5615
5616 static char *
5617 gen_internal_sym (prefix)
5618 const char *prefix;
5619 {
5620 char buf[256];
5621 static int label_num;
5622
5623 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
5624 return xstrdup (buf);
5625 }
5626
5627 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
5628
5629 static void
5630 assign_symbol_names (die)
5631 dw_die_ref die;
5632 {
5633 dw_die_ref c;
5634
5635 if (is_symbol_die (die))
5636 {
5637 if (comdat_symbol_id)
5638 {
5639 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
5640
5641 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
5642 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
5643 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
5644 }
5645 else
5646 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
5647 }
5648
5649 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5650 assign_symbol_names (c);
5651 }
5652
5653 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
5654 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
5655 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
5656
5657 static void
5658 break_out_includes (die)
5659 dw_die_ref die;
5660 {
5661 dw_die_ref *ptr;
5662 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
5663 limbo_die_node *node;
5664
5665 for (ptr = &(die->die_child); *ptr; )
5666 {
5667 dw_die_ref c = *ptr;
5668
5669 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
5670 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
5671 {
5672 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
5673 *ptr = c->die_sib;
5674
5675 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
5676 {
5677 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
5678 free_die (c);
5679 }
5680 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
5681 {
5682 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
5683 free_die (c);
5684 }
5685 else
5686 add_child_die (unit, c);
5687 }
5688 else
5689 {
5690 /* Leave this DIE in the main CU. */
5691 ptr = &(c->die_sib);
5692 continue;
5693 }
5694 }
5695
5696 #if 0
5697 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
5698 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
5699 if (unit != NULL)
5700 abort ();
5701 #endif
5702
5703 assign_symbol_names (die);
5704 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
5705 {
5706 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
5707 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
5708 }
5709 }
5710
5711 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
5712 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
5713 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
5714
5715 static void
5716 add_sibling_attributes (die)
5717 dw_die_ref die;
5718 {
5719 dw_die_ref c;
5720
5721 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5722 && die->die_sib && die->die_child != NULL)
5723 /* Add the sibling link to the front of the attribute list. */
5724 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
5725
5726 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5727 add_sibling_attributes (c);
5728 }
5729
5730 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
5731
5732 static void
5733 output_location_lists (die)
5734 dw_die_ref die;
5735 {
5736 dw_die_ref c;
5737 dw_attr_ref d_attr;
5738
5739 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
5740 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
5741 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (d_attr));
5742
5743 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5744 output_location_lists (c);
5745
5746 }
5747 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
5748 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
5749 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
5750 die are visited recursively. */
5751
5752 static void
5753 build_abbrev_table (die)
5754 dw_die_ref die;
5755 {
5756 unsigned long abbrev_id;
5757 unsigned int n_alloc;
5758 dw_die_ref c;
5759 dw_attr_ref d_attr, a_attr;
5760
5761 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
5762 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
5763 for (d_attr = die->die_attr; d_attr; d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next)
5764 if (AT_class (d_attr) == dw_val_class_die_ref
5765 && AT_ref (d_attr)->die_mark == 0)
5766 {
5767 if (AT_ref (d_attr)->die_symbol == 0)
5768 abort ();
5769
5770 set_AT_ref_external (d_attr, 1);
5771 }
5772
5773 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
5774 {
5775 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
5776
5777 if (abbrev->die_tag == die->die_tag)
5778 {
5779 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) == (die->die_child != NULL))
5780 {
5781 a_attr = abbrev->die_attr;
5782 d_attr = die->die_attr;
5783
5784 while (a_attr != NULL && d_attr != NULL)
5785 {
5786 if ((a_attr->dw_attr != d_attr->dw_attr)
5787 || (value_format (a_attr) != value_format (d_attr)))
5788 break;
5789
5790 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next;
5791 d_attr = d_attr->dw_attr_next;
5792 }
5793
5794 if (a_attr == NULL && d_attr == NULL)
5795 break;
5796 }
5797 }
5798 }
5799
5800 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
5801 {
5802 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
5803 {
5804 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
5805 abbrev_die_table
5806 = (dw_die_ref *) xrealloc (abbrev_die_table,
5807 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
5808
5809 memset ((char *) &abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
5810 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
5811 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
5812 }
5813
5814 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
5815 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
5816 }
5817
5818 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
5819 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5820 build_abbrev_table (c);
5821 }
5822 \f
5823 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
5824
5825 static int
5826 constant_size (value)
5827 long unsigned value;
5828 {
5829 int log;
5830
5831 if (value == 0)
5832 log = 0;
5833 else
5834 log = floor_log2 (value);
5835
5836 log = log / 8;
5837 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
5838
5839 return log;
5840 }
5841
5842 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
5843 .debug_info section. */
5844
5845 static unsigned long
5846 size_of_die (die)
5847 dw_die_ref die;
5848 {
5849 unsigned long size = 0;
5850 dw_attr_ref a;
5851
5852 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
5853 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
5854 {
5855 switch (AT_class (a))
5856 {
5857 case dw_val_class_addr:
5858 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
5859 break;
5860 case dw_val_class_offset:
5861 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5862 break;
5863 case dw_val_class_loc:
5864 {
5865 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
5866
5867 /* Block length. */
5868 size += constant_size (lsize);
5869 size += lsize;
5870 }
5871 break;
5872 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5873 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5874 break;
5875 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5876 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5877 break;
5878 case dw_val_class_const:
5879 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
5880 break;
5881 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5882 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
5883 break;
5884 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5885 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
5886 break;
5887 case dw_val_class_float:
5888 size += 1 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4; /* block */
5889 break;
5890 case dw_val_class_flag:
5891 size += 1;
5892 break;
5893 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5894 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5895 break;
5896 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5897 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5898 break;
5899 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5900 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
5901 break;
5902 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
5903 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5904 break;
5905 case dw_val_class_str:
5906 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
5907 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5908 else
5909 size += HT_LEN (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->id) + 1;
5910 break;
5911 default:
5912 abort ();
5913 }
5914 }
5915
5916 return size;
5917 }
5918
5919 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
5920 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
5921 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
5922 die_offset field in each DIE. */
5923
5924 static void
5925 calc_die_sizes (die)
5926 dw_die_ref die;
5927 {
5928 dw_die_ref c;
5929
5930 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
5931 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
5932
5933 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
5934 calc_die_sizes (c);
5935
5936 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5937 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
5938 next_die_offset += 1;
5939 }
5940
5941 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
5942 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
5943 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
5944 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
5945
5946 static void
5947 mark_dies (die)
5948 dw_die_ref die;
5949 {
5950 dw_die_ref c;
5951
5952 die->die_mark = 1;
5953 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5954 mark_dies (c);
5955 }
5956
5957 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
5958
5959 static void
5960 unmark_dies (die)
5961 dw_die_ref die;
5962 {
5963 dw_die_ref c;
5964
5965 die->die_mark = 0;
5966 for (c = die->die_child; c; c = c->die_sib)
5967 unmark_dies (c);
5968 }
5969
5970 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames table generated for the
5971 compilation unit. */
5972
5973 static unsigned long
5974 size_of_pubnames ()
5975 {
5976 unsigned long size;
5977 unsigned i;
5978
5979 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
5980 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
5981 {
5982 pubname_ref p = &pubname_table[i];
5983 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + strlen (p->name) + 1;
5984 }
5985
5986 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
5987 return size;
5988 }
5989
5990 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
5991
5992 static unsigned long
5993 size_of_aranges ()
5994 {
5995 unsigned long size;
5996
5997 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
5998
5999 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6000 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6001 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6002
6003 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6004 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6005 return size;
6006 }
6007 \f
6008 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6009
6010 static enum dwarf_form
6011 value_format (a)
6012 dw_attr_ref a;
6013 {
6014 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6015 {
6016 case dw_val_class_addr:
6017 return DW_FORM_addr;
6018 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6019 case dw_val_class_offset:
6020 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
6021 return DW_FORM_data4;
6022 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
6023 return DW_FORM_data8;
6024 abort ();
6025 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6026 /* FIXME: Could be DW_FORM_data8, with a > 32 bit size
6027 .debug_loc section */
6028 return DW_FORM_data4;
6029 case dw_val_class_loc:
6030 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6031 {
6032 case 1:
6033 return DW_FORM_block1;
6034 case 2:
6035 return DW_FORM_block2;
6036 default:
6037 abort ();
6038 }
6039 case dw_val_class_const:
6040 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6041 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6042 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6043 {
6044 case 1:
6045 return DW_FORM_data1;
6046 case 2:
6047 return DW_FORM_data2;
6048 case 4:
6049 return DW_FORM_data4;
6050 case 8:
6051 return DW_FORM_data8;
6052 default:
6053 abort ();
6054 }
6055 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6056 return DW_FORM_block1;
6057 case dw_val_class_float:
6058 return DW_FORM_block1;
6059 case dw_val_class_flag:
6060 return DW_FORM_flag;
6061 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6062 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6063 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6064 else
6065 return DW_FORM_ref;
6066 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6067 return DW_FORM_data;
6068 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6069 return DW_FORM_addr;
6070 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6071 return DW_FORM_data;
6072 case dw_val_class_str:
6073 return AT_string_form (a);
6074
6075 default:
6076 abort ();
6077 }
6078 }
6079
6080 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6081
6082 static void
6083 output_value_format (a)
6084 dw_attr_ref a;
6085 {
6086 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6087
6088 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6089 }
6090
6091 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6092 table. */
6093
6094 static void
6095 output_abbrev_section ()
6096 {
6097 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6098
6099 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6100
6101 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6102 {
6103 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6104
6105 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6106 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6107 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6108
6109 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6110 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6111 else
6112 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6113
6114 for (a_attr = abbrev->die_attr; a_attr != NULL;
6115 a_attr = a_attr->dw_attr_next)
6116 {
6117 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6118 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6119 output_value_format (a_attr);
6120 }
6121
6122 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6123 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6124 }
6125
6126 /* Terminate the table. */
6127 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6128 }
6129
6130 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6131
6132 static inline void
6133 output_die_symbol (die)
6134 dw_die_ref die;
6135 {
6136 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6137
6138 if (sym == 0)
6139 return;
6140
6141 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6142 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6143 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6144 will break. */
6145 ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6146
6147 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6148 }
6149
6150 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6151 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6152 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6153
6154 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6155 new_loc_list (expr, begin, end, section, gensym)
6156 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
6157 const char *begin;
6158 const char *end;
6159 const char *section;
6160 unsigned gensym;
6161 {
6162 dw_loc_list_ref retlist
6163 = (dw_loc_list_ref) xcalloc (1, sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6164
6165 retlist->begin = begin;
6166 retlist->end = end;
6167 retlist->expr = expr;
6168 retlist->section = section;
6169 if (gensym)
6170 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6171
6172 return retlist;
6173 }
6174
6175 /* Add a location description expression to a location list */
6176
6177 static inline void
6178 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (list_head, descr, begin, end, section)
6179 dw_loc_list_ref *list_head;
6180 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
6181 const char *begin;
6182 const char *end;
6183 const char *section;
6184 {
6185 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6186
6187 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6188 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6189 ;
6190
6191 /* Add a new location list node to the list */
6192 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6193 }
6194
6195 /* Output the location list given to us */
6196
6197 static void
6198 output_loc_list (list_head)
6199 dw_loc_list_ref list_head;
6200 {
6201 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
6202
6203 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
6204
6205 /* ??? This shouldn't be needed now that we've forced the
6206 compilation unit base address to zero when there is code
6207 in more than one section. */
6208 if (strcmp (curr->section, ".text") == 0)
6209 {
6210 /* dw2_asm_output_data will mask off any extra bits in the ~0. */
6211 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
6212 "Location list base address specifier fake entry");
6213 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->section,
6214 "Location list base address specifier base");
6215 }
6216
6217 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr=curr->dw_loc_next)
6218 {
6219 unsigned long size;
6220
6221 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
6222 "Location list begin address (%s)",
6223 list_head->ll_symbol);
6224 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
6225 "Location list end address (%s)",
6226 list_head->ll_symbol);
6227 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
6228
6229 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6230 if (size > 0xffff)
6231 abort ();
6232 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
6233
6234 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
6235 }
6236
6237 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
6238 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
6239 list_head->ll_symbol);
6240 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0,
6241 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
6242 list_head->ll_symbol);
6243 }
6244
6245 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
6246 the definitions of each child DIE. */
6247
6248 static void
6249 output_die (die)
6250 dw_die_ref die;
6251 {
6252 dw_attr_ref a;
6253 dw_die_ref c;
6254 unsigned long size;
6255
6256 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
6257 them to point to. */
6258 if (die->die_symbol)
6259 output_die_symbol (die);
6260
6261 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
6262 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
6263
6264 for (a = die->die_attr; a != NULL; a = a->dw_attr_next)
6265 {
6266 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
6267
6268 switch (AT_class (a))
6269 {
6270 case dw_val_class_addr:
6271 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
6272 break;
6273
6274 case dw_val_class_offset:
6275 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
6276 "%s", name);
6277 break;
6278
6279 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6280 {
6281 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
6282
6283 sprintf (p, "+0x%lx", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6284 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
6285 "%s", name);
6286 *p = '\0';
6287 }
6288 break;
6289
6290 case dw_val_class_loc:
6291 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6292
6293 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
6294 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
6295
6296 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
6297 break;
6298
6299 case dw_val_class_const:
6300 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
6301 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
6302 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
6303 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
6304 break;
6305
6306 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6307 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
6308 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
6309 break;
6310
6311 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6312 {
6313 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
6314
6315 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
6316 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6317 "%s", name);
6318
6319 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
6320 {
6321 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6322 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6323 }
6324 else
6325 {
6326 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
6327 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
6328 }
6329
6330 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6331 first, "long long constant");
6332 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
6333 second, NULL);
6334 }
6335 break;
6336
6337 case dw_val_class_float:
6338 {
6339 unsigned int i;
6340
6341 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length * 4,
6342 "%s", name);
6343
6344 for (i = 0; i < a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.length; i++)
6345 dw2_asm_output_data (4, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_float.array[i],
6346 "fp constant word %u", i);
6347 break;
6348 }
6349
6350 case dw_val_class_flag:
6351 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
6352 break;
6353
6354 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6355 {
6356 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
6357
6358 if (sym == 0)
6359 abort ();
6360 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym,
6361 loc_section_label, "%s", name);
6362 }
6363 break;
6364
6365 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6366 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6367 {
6368 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
6369
6370 if (sym == 0)
6371 abort ();
6372 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, "%s", name);
6373 }
6374 else if (AT_ref (a)->die_offset == 0)
6375 abort ();
6376 else
6377 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
6378 "%s", name);
6379 break;
6380
6381 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6382 {
6383 char l1[20];
6384
6385 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
6386 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
6387 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, "%s", name);
6388 }
6389 break;
6390
6391 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6392 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
6393 break;
6394
6395 case dw_val_class_lbl_offset:
6396 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
6397 break;
6398
6399 case dw_val_class_str:
6400 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6401 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
6402 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
6403 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
6404 else
6405 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
6406 break;
6407
6408 default:
6409 abort ();
6410 }
6411 }
6412
6413 for (c = die->die_child; c != NULL; c = c->die_sib)
6414 output_die (c);
6415
6416 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
6417 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6418 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
6419 die->die_offset);
6420 }
6421
6422 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
6423 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
6424
6425 static void
6426 output_compilation_unit_header ()
6427 {
6428 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
6429 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
6430 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
6431 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
6432 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
6433 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
6434 }
6435
6436 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
6437
6438 static void
6439 output_comp_unit (die)
6440 dw_die_ref die;
6441 {
6442 const char *secname;
6443
6444 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
6445 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
6446 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
6447 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
6448 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
6449 mark_dies (die);
6450
6451 build_abbrev_table (die);
6452
6453 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
6454 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
6455 calc_die_sizes (die);
6456
6457 if (die->die_symbol)
6458 {
6459 char *tmp = (char *) alloca (strlen (die->die_symbol) + 24);
6460
6461 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", die->die_symbol);
6462 secname = tmp;
6463 die->die_symbol = NULL;
6464 }
6465 else
6466 secname = (const char *) DEBUG_INFO_SECTION;
6467
6468 /* Output debugging information. */
6469 named_section_flags (secname, SECTION_DEBUG);
6470 output_compilation_unit_header ();
6471 output_die (die);
6472
6473 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
6474 output_pubnames. */
6475 if (die->die_symbol)
6476 unmark_dies (die);
6477 }
6478
6479 /* The DWARF2 pubname for a nested thingy looks like "A::f". The output
6480 of decl_printable_name for C++ looks like "A::f(int)". Let's drop the
6481 argument list, and maybe the scope. */
6482
6483 static const char *
6484 dwarf2_name (decl, scope)
6485 tree decl;
6486 int scope;
6487 {
6488 return (*decl_printable_name) (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
6489 }
6490
6491 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
6492
6493 static void
6494 add_pubname (decl, die)
6495 tree decl;
6496 dw_die_ref die;
6497 {
6498 pubname_ref p;
6499
6500 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
6501 return;
6502
6503 if (pubname_table_in_use == pubname_table_allocated)
6504 {
6505 pubname_table_allocated += PUBNAME_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6506 pubname_table
6507 = (pubname_ref) xrealloc (pubname_table,
6508 (pubname_table_allocated
6509 * sizeof (pubname_entry)));
6510 }
6511
6512 p = &pubname_table[pubname_table_in_use++];
6513 p->die = die;
6514 p->name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
6515 }
6516
6517 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
6518 visible names. For now, only generate entries for externally
6519 visible procedures. */
6520
6521 static void
6522 output_pubnames ()
6523 {
6524 unsigned i;
6525 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames ();
6526
6527 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
6528 "Length of Public Names Info");
6529 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
6530 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
6531 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
6532 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
6533 "Compilation Unit Length");
6534
6535 for (i = 0; i < pubname_table_in_use; i++)
6536 {
6537 pubname_ref pub = &pubname_table[i];
6538
6539 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
6540 if (pub->die->die_mark == 0)
6541 abort ();
6542
6543 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
6544 "DIE offset");
6545
6546 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
6547 }
6548
6549 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6550 }
6551
6552 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
6553
6554 static void
6555 add_arange (decl, die)
6556 tree decl;
6557 dw_die_ref die;
6558 {
6559 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
6560 return;
6561
6562 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
6563 {
6564 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6565 arange_table = (dw_die_ref *)
6566 xrealloc (arange_table, arange_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6567 }
6568
6569 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
6570 }
6571
6572 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
6573 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
6574 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
6575
6576 static void
6577 output_aranges ()
6578 {
6579 unsigned i;
6580 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
6581
6582 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
6583 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
6584 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
6585 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
6586 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
6587 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
6588 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
6589
6590 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
6591 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
6592 {
6593 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
6594 pointer size. */
6595 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
6596 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6597 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
6598 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
6599 }
6600
6601 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
6602 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
6603 text_section_label, "Length");
6604
6605 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
6606 {
6607 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
6608
6609 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
6610 if (die->die_mark == 0)
6611 abort ();
6612
6613 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
6614 {
6615 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
6616 "Address");
6617 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
6618 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
6619 }
6620 else
6621 {
6622 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
6623 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
6624 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
6625 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
6626 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6627
6628 if (! a || AT_class (a) != dw_val_class_loc)
6629 abort ();
6630
6631 loc = AT_loc (a);
6632 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_addr)
6633 abort ();
6634
6635 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
6636 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
6637 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
6638 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
6639 "Length");
6640 }
6641 }
6642
6643 /* Output the terminator words. */
6644 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6645 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6646 }
6647
6648 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
6649 was placed. */
6650
6651 static unsigned int
6652 add_ranges (block)
6653 tree block;
6654 {
6655 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
6656
6657 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
6658 {
6659 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6660 ranges_table = (dw_ranges_ref)
6661 xrealloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
6662 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
6663 }
6664
6665 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
6666 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
6667
6668 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6669 }
6670
6671 static void
6672 output_ranges ()
6673 {
6674 unsigned i;
6675 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
6676 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
6677
6678 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
6679 {
6680 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
6681
6682 if (block_num)
6683 {
6684 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6685 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6686
6687 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
6688 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
6689
6690 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
6691 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
6692 base of the text section. */
6693 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
6694 {
6695 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
6696 text_section_label,
6697 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6698 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
6699 text_section_label, NULL);
6700 }
6701
6702 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
6703 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
6704 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
6705 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
6706 else
6707 {
6708 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
6709 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
6710 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
6711 }
6712
6713 fmt = NULL;
6714 }
6715 else
6716 {
6717 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6718 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
6719 fmt = start_fmt;
6720 }
6721 }
6722 }
6723
6724 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
6725 struct file_info
6726 {
6727 char *path; /* Complete file name. */
6728 char *fname; /* File name part. */
6729 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
6730 int file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
6731 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
6732 };
6733
6734 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
6735 files. */
6736 struct dir_info
6737 {
6738 char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
6739 int length; /* Path length. */
6740 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
6741 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
6742 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
6743 int used; /* Used in the end? */
6744 };
6745
6746 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
6747 the directories in the path. */
6748
6749 static int
6750 file_info_cmp (p1, p2)
6751 const void *p1;
6752 const void *p2;
6753 {
6754 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
6755 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
6756 unsigned char *cp1;
6757 unsigned char *cp2;
6758
6759 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
6760 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
6761 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
6762 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
6763 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
6764 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
6765 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
6766
6767 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
6768 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
6769
6770 while (1)
6771 {
6772 ++cp1;
6773 ++cp2;
6774 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
6775 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
6776 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
6777 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
6778 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
6779
6780 /* Character of current path component the same? */
6781 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
6782 return *cp1 - *cp2;
6783 }
6784 }
6785
6786 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
6787 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
6788 slowdowns with many input files. */
6789
6790 static void
6791 output_file_names ()
6792 {
6793 struct file_info *files;
6794 struct dir_info *dirs;
6795 int *saved;
6796 int *savehere;
6797 int *backmap;
6798 int ndirs;
6799 int idx_offset;
6800 int i;
6801 int idx;
6802
6803 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
6804 files = (struct file_info *) alloca (file_table.in_use
6805 * sizeof (struct file_info));
6806 dirs = (struct dir_info *) alloca (file_table.in_use
6807 * sizeof (struct dir_info));
6808
6809 /* Sort the file names. */
6810 for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6811 {
6812 char *f;
6813
6814 /* Skip all leading "./". */
6815 f = file_table.table[i];
6816 while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
6817 f += 2;
6818
6819 /* Create a new array entry. */
6820 files[i].path = f;
6821 files[i].length = strlen (f);
6822 files[i].file_idx = i;
6823
6824 /* Search for the file name part. */
6825 f = strrchr (f, '/');
6826 files[i].fname = f == NULL ? files[i].path : f + 1;
6827 }
6828
6829 qsort (files + 1, file_table.in_use - 1, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
6830
6831 /* Find all the different directories used. */
6832 dirs[0].path = files[1].path;
6833 dirs[0].length = files[1].fname - files[1].path;
6834 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
6835 dirs[0].count = 1;
6836 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
6837 dirs[0].used = 0;
6838 files[1].dir_idx = 0;
6839 ndirs = 1;
6840
6841 for (i = 2; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6842 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
6843 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
6844 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
6845 {
6846 /* Same directory as last entry. */
6847 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
6848 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
6849 }
6850 else
6851 {
6852 int j;
6853
6854 /* This is a new directory. */
6855 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
6856 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
6857 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
6858 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
6859 dirs[ndirs].used = 0;
6860 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
6861
6862 /* Search for a prefix. */
6863 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
6864 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
6865 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
6866 && dirs[j].length > 1
6867 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
6868 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
6869 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
6870 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
6871
6872 ++ndirs;
6873 }
6874
6875 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
6876 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
6877 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
6878 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
6879 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
6880 results in most cases and never is much off. */
6881 saved = (int *) alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
6882 savehere = (int *) alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
6883
6884 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
6885 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
6886 {
6887 int j;
6888 int total;
6889
6890 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
6891 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
6892 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
6893 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
6894
6895 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
6896 {
6897 savehere[j] = 0;
6898 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
6899 {
6900 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
6901 dirs[j] path. */
6902 int k;
6903
6904 k = dirs[j].prefix;
6905 while (k != -1 && k != i)
6906 k = dirs[k].prefix;
6907
6908 if (k == i)
6909 {
6910 /* Yes it is. We can possibly safe some memory but
6911 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
6912 dirs[i]. */
6913 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
6914 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
6915 }
6916 }
6917 }
6918
6919 /* Check whether we can safe enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
6920 directory. */
6921 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
6922 {
6923 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
6924 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
6925 if (savehere[j] > 0)
6926 {
6927 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
6928 saved[j] = savehere[j];
6929
6930 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
6931 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
6932 }
6933 }
6934 }
6935
6936 /* We have to emit them in the order they appear in the file_table array
6937 since the index is used in the debug info generation. To do this
6938 efficiently we generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
6939 backmap = (int *) alloca (file_table.in_use * sizeof (int));
6940 for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6941 {
6942 backmap[files[i].file_idx] = i;
6943
6944 /* Mark this directory as used. */
6945 dirs[dirs[files[i].dir_idx].dir_idx].used = 1;
6946 }
6947
6948 /* That was it. We are ready to emit the information. First emit the
6949 directory name table. We have to make sure the first actually emitted
6950 directory name has index one; zero is reserved for the current working
6951 directory. Make sure we do not confuse these indices with the one for the
6952 constructed table (even though most of the time they are identical). */
6953 idx = 1;
6954 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
6955 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
6956 if (dirs[i].used != 0)
6957 {
6958 dirs[i].used = idx++;
6959 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
6960 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", dirs[i].used);
6961 }
6962
6963 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
6964
6965 /* Correct the index for the current working directory entry if it
6966 exists. */
6967 if (idx_offset == 0)
6968 dirs[0].used = 0;
6969
6970 /* Now write all the file names. */
6971 for (i = 1; i < (int) file_table.in_use; i++)
6972 {
6973 int file_idx = backmap[i];
6974 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
6975
6976 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
6977 "File Entry: 0x%x", i);
6978
6979 /* Include directory index. */
6980 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dirs[dir_idx].used, NULL);
6981
6982 /* Modification time. */
6983 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
6984
6985 /* File length in bytes. */
6986 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
6987 }
6988
6989 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
6990 }
6991
6992
6993 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
6994 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
6995
6996 static void
6997 output_line_info ()
6998 {
6999 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7000 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7001 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7002 unsigned opc;
7003 unsigned n_op_args;
7004 unsigned long lt_index;
7005 unsigned long current_line;
7006 long line_offset;
7007 long line_delta;
7008 unsigned long current_file;
7009 unsigned long function;
7010
7011 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7012 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7013 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7014 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7015
7016 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7017 "Length of Source Line Info");
7018 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7019
7020 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7021 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7022 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7023
7024 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7025 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7026 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7027 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7028 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7029 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7030 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7031 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7032 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7033 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7034
7035 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7036 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7037 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7038 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7039 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7040 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7041 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7042 "Special Opcode Base");
7043
7044 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7045 {
7046 switch (opc)
7047 {
7048 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7049 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7050 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7051 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7052 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7053 n_op_args = 1;
7054 break;
7055 default:
7056 n_op_args = 0;
7057 break;
7058 }
7059
7060 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7061 opc, n_op_args);
7062 }
7063
7064 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7065 output_file_names ();
7066 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7067
7068 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7069 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7070 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
7071
7072 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7073 a series of state machine operations. */
7074 current_file = 1;
7075 current_line = 1;
7076 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7077 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7078 {
7079 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7080
7081 #if 0
7082 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7083 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
7084 prologue. */
7085
7086 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
7087 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
7088 that anything after the last address is this line. */
7089 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7090 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
7091 continue;
7092 #endif
7093
7094 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
7095
7096 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
7097 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
7098 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
7099 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
7100 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
7101 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
7102
7103 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
7104 if (0)
7105 {
7106 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
7107 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7108 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7109 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7110 }
7111 else
7112 {
7113 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
7114 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
7115 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7116 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7117 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7118 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7119 }
7120
7121 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7122
7123 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7124 different from the previous line. */
7125 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7126 {
7127 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7128 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7129 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7130 file_table.table[current_file]);
7131 }
7132
7133 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7134 that uses the least amount of space. */
7135 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7136 {
7137 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7138 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7139 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7140 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7141 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
7142 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
7143 takes 1 byte. */
7144 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7145 "line %lu", current_line);
7146 else
7147 {
7148 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
7149 depending on the value being encoded. */
7150 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7151 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7152 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7153 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7154 }
7155 }
7156 else
7157 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
7158 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7159 }
7160
7161 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7162 if (0)
7163 {
7164 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7165 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7166 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7167 }
7168 else
7169 {
7170 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7171 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7172 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7173 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
7174 }
7175
7176 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7177 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7178 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7179
7180 function = 0;
7181 current_file = 1;
7182 current_line = 1;
7183 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
7184 {
7185 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
7186 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
7187
7188 #if 0
7189 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
7190 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
7191 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
7192 && line_info->function == function)
7193 goto cont;
7194 #endif
7195
7196 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
7197 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
7198 to handle it differently. */
7199 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
7200 lt_index);
7201 if (function != line_info->function)
7202 {
7203 function = line_info->function;
7204
7205 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function */
7206 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7207 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7208 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7209 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7210 }
7211 else
7212 {
7213 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
7214 if (0)
7215 {
7216 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7217 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7218 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7219 }
7220 else
7221 {
7222 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7223 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7224 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7225 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7226 }
7227 }
7228
7229 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
7230
7231 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
7232 different from the previous line. */
7233 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
7234 {
7235 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
7236 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
7237 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "(\"%s\")",
7238 file_table.table[current_file]);
7239 }
7240
7241 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
7242 that uses the least amount of space. */
7243 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
7244 {
7245 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
7246 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
7247 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
7248 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
7249 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
7250 "line %lu", current_line);
7251 else
7252 {
7253 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
7254 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
7255 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
7256 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7257 }
7258 }
7259 else
7260 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
7261
7262 #if 0
7263 cont:
7264 #endif
7265
7266 lt_index++;
7267
7268 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
7269 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
7270 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
7271 {
7272 current_file = 1;
7273 current_line = 1;
7274
7275 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
7276 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
7277 if (0)
7278 {
7279 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
7280 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
7281 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
7282 }
7283 else
7284 {
7285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
7286 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
7287 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
7288 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
7289 }
7290
7291 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
7292 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
7293 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
7294 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
7295 }
7296 }
7297
7298 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
7299 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
7300 }
7301 \f
7302 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
7303 a DIE that describes the given type.
7304
7305 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
7306 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
7307
7308 static dw_die_ref
7309 base_type_die (type)
7310 tree type;
7311 {
7312 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
7313 const char *type_name;
7314 enum dwarf_type encoding;
7315 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
7316
7317 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
7318 return 0;
7319
7320 if (name)
7321 {
7322 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
7323 name = DECL_NAME (name);
7324
7325 type_name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name);
7326 }
7327 else
7328 type_name = "__unknown__";
7329
7330 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7331 {
7332 case INTEGER_TYPE:
7333 /* Carefully distinguish the C character types, without messing
7334 up if the language is not C. Note that we check only for the names
7335 that contain spaces; other names might occur by coincidence in other
7336 languages. */
7337 if (! (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
7338 && (type == char_type_node
7339 || ! strcmp (type_name, "signed char")
7340 || ! strcmp (type_name, "unsigned char"))))
7341 {
7342 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
7343 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
7344 else
7345 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
7346 break;
7347 }
7348 /* else fall through. */
7349
7350 case CHAR_TYPE:
7351 /* GNU Pascal/Ada CHAR type. Not used in C. */
7352 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (type))
7353 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
7354 else
7355 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
7356 break;
7357
7358 case REAL_TYPE:
7359 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
7360 break;
7361
7362 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
7363 a user defined type for it. */
7364 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
7365 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
7366 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
7367 else
7368 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
7369 break;
7370
7371 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
7372 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
7373 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
7374 break;
7375
7376 default:
7377 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
7378 abort ();
7379 }
7380
7381 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7382 if (demangle_name_func)
7383 type_name = (*demangle_name_func) (type_name);
7384
7385 add_AT_string (base_type_result, DW_AT_name, type_name);
7386 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
7387 int_size_in_bytes (type));
7388 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
7389
7390 return base_type_result;
7391 }
7392
7393 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
7394 the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type. The Dwarf "root" type of
7395 a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
7396 given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
7397 type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
7398 type. (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
7399 type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
7400 root type of the given type without the qualifiers. */
7401
7402 static tree
7403 root_type (type)
7404 tree type;
7405 {
7406 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
7407 return error_mark_node;
7408
7409 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7410 {
7411 case ERROR_MARK:
7412 return error_mark_node;
7413
7414 case POINTER_TYPE:
7415 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
7416 return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
7417
7418 default:
7419 return type_main_variant (type);
7420 }
7421 }
7422
7423 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return non-zero if the
7424 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
7425
7426 static inline int
7427 is_base_type (type)
7428 tree type;
7429 {
7430 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7431 {
7432 case ERROR_MARK:
7433 case VOID_TYPE:
7434 case INTEGER_TYPE:
7435 case REAL_TYPE:
7436 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
7437 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
7438 case CHAR_TYPE:
7439 return 1;
7440
7441 case SET_TYPE:
7442 case ARRAY_TYPE:
7443 case RECORD_TYPE:
7444 case UNION_TYPE:
7445 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
7446 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
7447 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
7448 case METHOD_TYPE:
7449 case POINTER_TYPE:
7450 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
7451 case FILE_TYPE:
7452 case OFFSET_TYPE:
7453 case LANG_TYPE:
7454 case VECTOR_TYPE:
7455 return 0;
7456
7457 default:
7458 abort ();
7459 }
7460
7461 return 0;
7462 }
7463
7464 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
7465 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
7466
7467 static dw_die_ref
7468 modified_type_die (type, is_const_type, is_volatile_type, context_die)
7469 tree type;
7470 int is_const_type;
7471 int is_volatile_type;
7472 dw_die_ref context_die;
7473 {
7474 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
7475 dw_die_ref mod_type_die = NULL;
7476 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
7477 tree item_type = NULL;
7478
7479 if (code != ERROR_MARK)
7480 {
7481 tree qualified_type;
7482
7483 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
7484 this type. */
7485 qualified_type
7486 = get_qualified_type (type,
7487 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
7488 | (is_volatile_type
7489 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
7490
7491 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
7492 if (qualified_type)
7493 {
7494 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
7495 if (mod_type_die)
7496 return mod_type_die;
7497 }
7498
7499 /* Handle C typedef types. */
7500 if (qualified_type && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
7501 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL
7502 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)))
7503 {
7504 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (qualified_type);
7505 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (type_name);
7506
7507 if (qualified_type == dtype)
7508 {
7509 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
7510 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
7511 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
7512 }
7513 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
7514 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype))
7515 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
7516 type to which it refers. */
7517 mod_type_die
7518 = modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (type_name),
7519 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
7520 context_die);
7521
7522 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
7523 }
7524
7525 if (mod_type_die)
7526 /* OK. */
7527 ;
7528 else if (is_const_type)
7529 {
7530 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7531 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
7532 }
7533 else if (is_volatile_type)
7534 {
7535 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7536 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
7537 }
7538 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
7539 {
7540 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7541 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
7542 #if 0
7543 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
7544 #endif
7545 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
7546 }
7547 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
7548 {
7549 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
7550 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
7551 #if 0
7552 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, 0);
7553 #endif
7554 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
7555 }
7556 else if (is_base_type (type))
7557 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
7558 else
7559 {
7560 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
7561
7562 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
7563 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
7564 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
7565 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
7566 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
7567 ..._TYPE node. */
7568 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
7569 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
7570 else
7571 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
7572 not the main variant. */
7573 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
7574 if (mod_type_die == NULL)
7575 abort ();
7576 }
7577
7578 /* We want to equate the qualified type to the die below. */
7579 if (qualified_type)
7580 type = qualified_type;
7581 }
7582
7583 equate_type_number_to_die (type, mod_type_die);
7584 if (item_type)
7585 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
7586 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
7587 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
7588 types are possible in Ada. */
7589 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
7590 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
7591 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
7592 context_die);
7593
7594 if (sub_die != NULL)
7595 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
7596
7597 return mod_type_die;
7598 }
7599
7600 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
7601 an enumerated type. */
7602
7603 static inline int
7604 type_is_enum (type)
7605 tree type;
7606 {
7607 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
7608 }
7609
7610 /* Return the register number described by a given RTL node. */
7611
7612 static unsigned int
7613 reg_number (rtl)
7614 rtx rtl;
7615 {
7616 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
7617
7618 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7619 abort ();
7620
7621 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
7622 }
7623
7624 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
7625 zero if there is no such. */
7626
7627 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7628 reg_loc_descriptor (rtl)
7629 rtx rtl;
7630 {
7631 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
7632 unsigned reg;
7633
7634 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7635 return 0;
7636
7637 reg = reg_number (rtl);
7638 if (reg <= 31)
7639 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + reg, 0, 0);
7640 else
7641 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, reg, 0);
7642
7643 return loc_result;
7644 }
7645
7646 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
7647
7648 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7649 int_loc_descriptor (i)
7650 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
7651 {
7652 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
7653
7654 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
7655 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
7656 if (i >= 0)
7657 {
7658 if (i <= 31)
7659 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
7660 else if (i <= 0xff)
7661 op = DW_OP_const1u;
7662 else if (i <= 0xffff)
7663 op = DW_OP_const2u;
7664 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
7665 || i <= 0xffffffff)
7666 op = DW_OP_const4u;
7667 else
7668 op = DW_OP_constu;
7669 }
7670 else
7671 {
7672 if (i >= -0x80)
7673 op = DW_OP_const1s;
7674 else if (i >= -0x8000)
7675 op = DW_OP_const2s;
7676 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
7677 || i >= -0x80000000)
7678 op = DW_OP_const4s;
7679 else
7680 op = DW_OP_consts;
7681 }
7682
7683 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
7684 }
7685
7686 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
7687
7688 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7689 based_loc_descr (reg, offset)
7690 unsigned reg;
7691 long int offset;
7692 {
7693 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
7694 /* For the "frame base", we use the frame pointer or stack pointer
7695 registers, since the RTL for local variables is relative to one of
7696 them. */
7697 unsigned fp_reg = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (frame_pointer_needed
7698 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
7699 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
7700
7701 if (reg == fp_reg)
7702 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
7703 else if (reg <= 31)
7704 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + reg, offset, 0);
7705 else
7706 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
7707
7708 return loc_result;
7709 }
7710
7711 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
7712
7713 static inline int
7714 is_based_loc (rtl)
7715 rtx rtl;
7716 {
7717 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
7718 && ((GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == REG
7719 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
7720 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
7721 }
7722
7723 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
7724 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
7725 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
7726 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
7727
7728 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
7729 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
7730 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
7731 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
7732
7733 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
7734 autoincrement addressing modes.
7735
7736 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
7737
7738 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7739 mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode)
7740 rtx rtl;
7741 enum machine_mode mode;
7742 {
7743 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
7744
7745 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
7746 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
7747 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
7748 zeroth element of the array. */
7749
7750 #ifdef ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR
7751 rtl = ASM_SIMPLIFY_DWARF_ADDR (rtl);
7752 #endif
7753
7754 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
7755 {
7756 case POST_INC:
7757 case POST_DEC:
7758 case POST_MODIFY:
7759 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
7760 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
7761
7762 /* ... fall through ... */
7763
7764 case SUBREG:
7765 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
7766 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
7767 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
7768 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
7769 contains the given subreg. */
7770 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
7771
7772 /* ... fall through ... */
7773
7774 case REG:
7775 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
7776 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
7777 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
7778 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
7779 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
7780 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
7781 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
7782 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
7783 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
7784 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
7785 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
7786 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
7787 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
7788 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7789 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (rtl), 0);
7790 break;
7791
7792 case MEM:
7793 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
7794 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
7795 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
7796 break;
7797
7798 case LABEL_REF:
7799 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
7800 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
7801 pool. */
7802 case CONST:
7803 case SYMBOL_REF:
7804 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
7805 by a different symbol. */
7806 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
7807 {
7808 bool marked;
7809 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
7810
7811 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
7812 {
7813 rtl = tmp;
7814 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
7815 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
7816 else
7817 marked = true;
7818 }
7819
7820 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
7821 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
7822 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
7823 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
7824 if (!marked)
7825 return 0;
7826 }
7827
7828 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
7829 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
7830 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
7831 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
7832 break;
7833
7834 case PRE_MODIFY:
7835 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
7836 PLUS code below. */
7837 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
7838 goto plus;
7839
7840 case PRE_INC:
7841 case PRE_DEC:
7842 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
7843 below. */
7844 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
7845 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
7846 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
7847 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
7848
7849 /* ... fall through ... */
7850
7851 case PLUS:
7852 plus:
7853 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
7854 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (reg_number (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
7855 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
7856 else
7857 {
7858 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
7859 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
7860 break;
7861
7862 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
7863 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
7864 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
7865 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
7866 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
7867 else
7868 {
7869 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
7870 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
7871 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
7872 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
7873 }
7874 }
7875 break;
7876
7877 case MULT:
7878 {
7879 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
7880 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply. */
7881 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
7882 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
7883
7884 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
7885 break;
7886
7887 mem_loc_result = op0;
7888 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
7889 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
7890 break;
7891 }
7892
7893 case CONST_INT:
7894 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
7895 break;
7896
7897 case ADDRESSOF:
7898 /* If this is a MEM, return its address. Otherwise, we can't
7899 represent this. */
7900 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == MEM)
7901 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0), mode);
7902 else
7903 return 0;
7904
7905 default:
7906 abort ();
7907 }
7908
7909 return mem_loc_result;
7910 }
7911
7912 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
7913 This is typically a complex variable. */
7914
7915 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7916 concat_loc_descriptor (x0, x1)
7917 rtx x0, x1;
7918 {
7919 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
7920 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
7921 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
7922
7923 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
7924 return 0;
7925
7926 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
7927 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
7928 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
7929 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)), 0));
7930
7931 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
7932 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result,
7933 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece,
7934 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)), 0));
7935
7936 return cc_loc_result;
7937 }
7938
7939 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
7940 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
7941 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
7942 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
7943 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
7944
7945 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
7946
7947 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7948 loc_descriptor (rtl)
7949 rtx rtl;
7950 {
7951 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
7952
7953 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
7954 {
7955 case SUBREG:
7956 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
7957 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
7958 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
7959 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
7960 contains the given subreg. */
7961 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
7962
7963 /* ... fall through ... */
7964
7965 case REG:
7966 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
7967 break;
7968
7969 case MEM:
7970 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
7971 break;
7972
7973 case CONCAT:
7974 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
7975 break;
7976
7977 default:
7978 abort ();
7979 }
7980
7981 return loc_result;
7982 }
7983
7984 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
7985 up particularly with variable length arrays. If ADDRESSP is nonzero, we are
7986 looking for an address. Otherwise, we return a value. If we can't make a
7987 descriptor, return 0. */
7988
7989 static dw_loc_descr_ref
7990 loc_descriptor_from_tree (loc, addressp)
7991 tree loc;
7992 int addressp;
7993 {
7994 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
7995 int indirect_p = 0;
7996 int unsignedp = TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
7997 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
7998
7999 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
8000 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
8001 problem... */
8002
8003 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
8004 {
8005 case ERROR_MARK:
8006 return 0;
8007
8008 case WITH_RECORD_EXPR:
8009 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
8010 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
8011 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
8012 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
8013 the names of types. */
8014 return 0;
8015
8016 case CALL_EXPR:
8017 return 0;
8018
8019 case ADDR_EXPR:
8020 /* We can support this only if we can look through conversions and
8021 find an INDIRECT_EXPR. */
8022 for (loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0);
8023 TREE_CODE (loc) == CONVERT_EXPR || TREE_CODE (loc) == NOP_EXPR
8024 || TREE_CODE (loc) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
8025 || TREE_CODE (loc) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
8026 || TREE_CODE (loc) == SAVE_EXPR;
8027 loc = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
8028 ;
8029
8030 return (TREE_CODE (loc) == INDIRECT_REF
8031 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp)
8032 : 0);
8033
8034 case VAR_DECL:
8035 case PARM_DECL:
8036 {
8037 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
8038
8039 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
8040 return 0;
8041 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
8042 {
8043 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8044 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8045 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8046 indirect_p = 1;
8047 }
8048 else
8049 {
8050 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
8051
8052 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM)
8053 {
8054 indirect_p = 1;
8055 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8056 }
8057
8058 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
8059 }
8060 }
8061 break;
8062
8063 case INDIRECT_REF:
8064 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8065 indirect_p = 1;
8066 break;
8067
8068 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
8069 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), addressp);
8070
8071 case NOP_EXPR:
8072 case CONVERT_EXPR:
8073 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8074 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
8075 case SAVE_EXPR:
8076 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), addressp);
8077
8078 case COMPONENT_REF:
8079 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
8080 case ARRAY_REF:
8081 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
8082 {
8083 tree obj, offset;
8084 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
8085 enum machine_mode mode;
8086 int volatilep;
8087
8088 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
8089 &unsignedp, &volatilep);
8090
8091 if (obj == loc)
8092 return 0;
8093
8094 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (obj, 1);
8095 if (ret == 0
8096 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
8097 return 0;
8098
8099 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
8100 {
8101 /* Variable offset. */
8102 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree (offset, 0));
8103 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8104 }
8105
8106 if (!addressp)
8107 indirect_p = 1;
8108
8109 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
8110 if (bytepos > 0)
8111 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
8112 else if (bytepos < 0)
8113 {
8114 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
8115 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8116 }
8117 break;
8118 }
8119
8120 case INTEGER_CST:
8121 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
8122 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
8123 else
8124 return 0;
8125 break;
8126
8127 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
8128 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
8129 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8130 op = DW_OP_and;
8131 goto do_binop;
8132
8133 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
8134 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8135 op = DW_OP_xor;
8136 goto do_binop;
8137
8138 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
8139 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
8140 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8141 op = DW_OP_or;
8142 goto do_binop;
8143
8144 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8145 op = DW_OP_div;
8146 goto do_binop;
8147
8148 case MINUS_EXPR:
8149 op = DW_OP_minus;
8150 goto do_binop;
8151
8152 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8153 op = DW_OP_mod;
8154 goto do_binop;
8155
8156 case MULT_EXPR:
8157 op = DW_OP_mul;
8158 goto do_binop;
8159
8160 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8161 op = DW_OP_shl;
8162 goto do_binop;
8163
8164 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8165 op = (unsignedp ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
8166 goto do_binop;
8167
8168 case PLUS_EXPR:
8169 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8170 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
8171 {
8172 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8173 if (ret == 0)
8174 return 0;
8175
8176 add_loc_descr (&ret,
8177 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8178 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
8179 0),
8180 0));
8181 break;
8182 }
8183
8184 op = DW_OP_plus;
8185 goto do_binop;
8186
8187 case LE_EXPR:
8188 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8189 return 0;
8190
8191 op = DW_OP_le;
8192 goto do_binop;
8193
8194 case GE_EXPR:
8195 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8196 return 0;
8197
8198 op = DW_OP_ge;
8199 goto do_binop;
8200
8201 case LT_EXPR:
8202 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8203 return 0;
8204
8205 op = DW_OP_lt;
8206 goto do_binop;
8207
8208 case GT_EXPR:
8209 if (TREE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
8210 return 0;
8211
8212 op = DW_OP_gt;
8213 goto do_binop;
8214
8215 case EQ_EXPR:
8216 op = DW_OP_eq;
8217 goto do_binop;
8218
8219 case NE_EXPR:
8220 op = DW_OP_ne;
8221 goto do_binop;
8222
8223 do_binop:
8224 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8225 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
8226 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
8227 return 0;
8228
8229 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
8230 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8231 break;
8232
8233 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
8234 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8235 op = DW_OP_not;
8236 goto do_unop;
8237
8238 case ABS_EXPR:
8239 op = DW_OP_abs;
8240 goto do_unop;
8241
8242 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8243 op = DW_OP_neg;
8244 goto do_unop;
8245
8246 do_unop:
8247 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8248 if (ret == 0)
8249 return 0;
8250
8251 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
8252 break;
8253
8254 case MAX_EXPR:
8255 loc = build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
8256 build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
8257 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
8258 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
8259
8260 /* ... fall through ... */
8261
8262 case COND_EXPR:
8263 {
8264 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
8265 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
8266 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
8267 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
8268 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
8269
8270 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
8271 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
8272 return 0;
8273
8274 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
8275 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
8276
8277 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
8278 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
8279 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
8280
8281 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
8282 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
8283 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
8284
8285 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
8286 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
8287 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
8288 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
8289 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
8290 }
8291 break;
8292
8293 default:
8294 abort ();
8295 }
8296
8297 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
8298 if (addressp && indirect_p == 0)
8299 return 0;
8300
8301 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
8302 if (!addressp && indirect_p > 0)
8303 {
8304 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
8305
8306 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
8307 return 0;
8308 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8309 op = DW_OP_deref;
8310 else
8311 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
8312
8313 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
8314 }
8315
8316 return ret;
8317 }
8318
8319 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
8320 which is not less than the value itself. */
8321
8322 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
8323 ceiling (value, boundary)
8324 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
8325 unsigned int boundary;
8326 {
8327 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
8328 }
8329
8330 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
8331 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
8332 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
8333 ERROR_MARK node. */
8334
8335 static inline tree
8336 field_type (decl)
8337 tree decl;
8338 {
8339 tree type;
8340
8341 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8342 return integer_type_node;
8343
8344 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
8345 if (type == NULL_TREE)
8346 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
8347
8348 return type;
8349 }
8350
8351 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
8352 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
8353 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
8354
8355 static inline unsigned
8356 simple_type_align_in_bits (type)
8357 tree type;
8358 {
8359 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
8360 }
8361
8362 static inline unsigned
8363 simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl)
8364 tree decl;
8365 {
8366 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
8367 }
8368
8369 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8370 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8371 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8372 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8373 ERROR_MARK node. */
8374
8375 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8376 simple_type_size_in_bits (type)
8377 tree type;
8378 {
8379
8380 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8381 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8382 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8383 return 0;
8384 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8385 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8386 else
8387 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8388 }
8389
8390 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
8391 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
8392 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
8393 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
8394 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
8395 just yet). */
8396
8397 static HOST_WIDE_INT
8398 field_byte_offset (decl)
8399 tree decl;
8400 {
8401 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
8402 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
8403 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
8404 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
8405 tree type;
8406 tree field_size_tree;
8407 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
8408 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
8409 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
8410
8411 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8412 return 0;
8413 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
8414 abort ();
8415
8416 type = field_type (decl);
8417 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
8418
8419 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
8420 a flexible array member. */
8421 if (! field_size_tree)
8422 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
8423
8424 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
8425 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
8426 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
8427 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
8428 return 0;
8429
8430 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
8431
8432 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
8433 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
8434 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
8435 else
8436 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
8437
8438 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
8439 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
8440 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
8441
8442 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
8443 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
8444 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
8445 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
8446 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
8447 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
8448 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
8449 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
8450
8451 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
8452
8453 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
8454 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
8455 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
8456 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
8457 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
8458 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
8459 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
8460 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
8461 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
8462 bits of the bit-field itself.
8463
8464 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
8465 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
8466 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
8467 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
8468 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
8469 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
8470 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
8471 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
8472 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
8473
8474 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
8475 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
8476 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
8477 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
8478 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
8479 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
8480
8481 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
8482 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
8483 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
8484
8485 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
8486 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
8487 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
8488
8489 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
8490 object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
8491 object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
8492 object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
8493
8494 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
8495 {
8496 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
8497 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
8498
8499 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
8500 object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
8501 object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
8502 object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
8503 }
8504
8505 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
8506 }
8507 \f
8508 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
8509 associated with them. */
8510
8511 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
8512
8513 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
8514 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
8515 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
8516
8517 static void
8518 add_AT_location_description (die, attr_kind, rtl)
8519 dw_die_ref die;
8520 enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind;
8521 rtx rtl;
8522 {
8523 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = loc_descriptor (rtl);
8524
8525 if (descr != 0)
8526 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
8527 }
8528
8529 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
8530 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
8531 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
8532 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
8533 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
8534 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
8535 function above).
8536
8537 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
8538 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
8539 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
8540 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
8541 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
8542 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
8543 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
8544 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
8545 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
8546 function below.) */
8547
8548 static void
8549 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, decl)
8550 dw_die_ref die;
8551 tree decl;
8552 {
8553 long offset;
8554 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
8555
8556 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_VEC)
8557 {
8558 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
8559 if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (decl) && is_cxx ())
8560 {
8561 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
8562 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
8563 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
8564 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
8565
8566 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
8567
8568 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
8569
8570 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
8571
8572 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
8573 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
8574 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8575
8576 /* Extract the vtable address. */
8577 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
8578 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8579
8580 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
8581 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
8582 if (offset >= 0)
8583 abort ();
8584
8585 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
8586 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8587 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
8588 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8589
8590 /* Extract the offset. */
8591 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
8592 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8593
8594 /* Add it to the object address. */
8595 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
8596 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
8597 }
8598 else
8599 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
8600 }
8601 else
8602 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
8603
8604 if (! loc_descr)
8605 {
8606 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8607
8608 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
8609 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
8610 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
8611
8612 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8613 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
8614 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
8615 stack. */
8616 op = DW_OP_constu;
8617 #else
8618 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
8619 #endif
8620
8621 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
8622 }
8623
8624 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
8625 }
8626
8627 /* Attach an DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
8628 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
8629 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
8630 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
8631 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
8632
8633 static void
8634 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl)
8635 dw_die_ref die;
8636 rtx rtl;
8637 {
8638 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8639 {
8640 case CONST_INT:
8641 /* Note that a CONST_INT rtx could represent either an integer
8642 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_INT is used whenever
8643 the constant will fit into a single word. In all such
8644 cases, the original mode of the constant value is wiped
8645 out, and the CONST_INT rtx is assigned VOIDmode. */
8646 {
8647 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
8648
8649 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
8650 if (val < 0 && (long) val == val)
8651 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, (long) val);
8652 else if ((unsigned long) val == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val)
8653 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned long) val);
8654 else
8655 {
8656 #if HOST_BITS_PER_LONG * 2 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8657 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
8658 val >> HOST_BITS_PER_LONG, val);
8659 #else
8660 abort ();
8661 #endif
8662 }
8663 }
8664 break;
8665
8666 case CONST_DOUBLE:
8667 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
8668 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
8669 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
8670 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
8671 {
8672 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
8673
8674 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
8675 {
8676 unsigned length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / 4;
8677 long *array = (long *) xmalloc (sizeof (long) * length);
8678 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
8679
8680 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
8681 switch (mode)
8682 {
8683 case SFmode:
8684 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (rv, array[0]);
8685 break;
8686
8687 case DFmode:
8688 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (rv, array);
8689 break;
8690
8691 case XFmode:
8692 case TFmode:
8693 REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (rv, array);
8694 break;
8695
8696 default:
8697 abort ();
8698 }
8699
8700 add_AT_float (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, array);
8701 }
8702 else
8703 {
8704 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
8705 if (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG != HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8706 abort ();
8707
8708 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
8709 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
8710 }
8711 }
8712 break;
8713
8714 case CONST_STRING:
8715 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
8716 break;
8717
8718 case SYMBOL_REF:
8719 case LABEL_REF:
8720 case CONST:
8721 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
8722 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, rtl);
8723 break;
8724
8725 case PLUS:
8726 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
8727 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
8728 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
8729 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
8730 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
8731 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
8732 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
8733 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
8734 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
8735 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
8736 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
8737 break;
8738
8739 default:
8740 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
8741 abort ();
8742 }
8743
8744 }
8745
8746 static rtx
8747 rtl_for_decl_location (decl)
8748 tree decl;
8749 {
8750 rtx rtl;
8751
8752 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
8753 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
8754 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
8755
8756 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
8757 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
8758 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
8759 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
8760 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
8761 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
8762 referenced within the function.
8763
8764 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
8765 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
8766 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
8767 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
8768
8769 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
8770 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
8771 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
8772 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
8773 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
8774 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
8775
8776 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
8777 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
8778 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
8779 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
8780 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
8781 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
8782 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
8783 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
8784 output at debug-time.
8785
8786 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
8787 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
8788 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
8789 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
8790 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
8791 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
8792 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
8793 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
8794 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
8795 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
8796 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
8797 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
8798 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
8799
8800 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
8801 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
8802 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
8803 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
8804 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
8805 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
8806 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
8807 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
8808 I'd like to fix it.
8809
8810 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
8811 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
8812 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
8813 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
8814 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
8815 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
8816 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
8817 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
8818 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
8819 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
8820 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values, but integrate.c doesn't currently generate these
8821 values for inlined instances of inline function parameters, so when we see
8822 such cases, we are just out-of-luck for the time being (until integrate.c
8823 gets fixed). */
8824
8825 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
8826 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
8827
8828 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
8829 constants and symbols living in memory. */
8830 if (! reload_completed)
8831 {
8832 if (rtl
8833 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
8834 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
8835 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))))
8836 return rtl;
8837 rtl = NULL_RTX;
8838 }
8839 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
8840 {
8841 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
8842 {
8843 tree declared_type = type_main_variant (TREE_TYPE (decl));
8844 tree passed_type = type_main_variant (DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl));
8845
8846 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
8847 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
8848 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
8849 if (declared_type == passed_type)
8850 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
8851 else if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
8852 && TREE_CODE (declared_type) == INTEGER_TYPE
8853 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (declared_type))
8854 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (passed_type))))
8855 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
8856 }
8857
8858 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
8859 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
8860 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
8861 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
8862 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
8863 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
8864 thing to do. */
8865 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == MEM
8866 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
8867 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8868 /* Not passed in memory. */
8869 && GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)) != MEM
8870 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
8871 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != REG
8872 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
8873 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
8874 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
8875 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
8876 #endif
8877 )
8878 /* Big endian correction check. */
8879 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
8880 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
8881 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
8882 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
8883 {
8884 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
8885 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
8886
8887 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
8888 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
8889 }
8890 }
8891
8892 if (rtl != NULL_RTX)
8893 {
8894 rtl = eliminate_regs (rtl, 0, NULL_RTX);
8895 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8896 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8897 leaf_renumber_regs_insn (rtl);
8898 #endif
8899 }
8900
8901 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
8902 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
8903 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
8904 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
8905 rtl = expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (decl), NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
8906 EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
8907
8908 return rtl;
8909 }
8910
8911 /* Generate *either* an DW_AT_location attribute or else an DW_AT_const_value
8912 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
8913 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
8914 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
8915 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
8916 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
8917 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
8918 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
8919 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
8920 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
8921
8922 static void
8923 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl)
8924 dw_die_ref die;
8925 tree decl;
8926 {
8927 rtx rtl;
8928
8929 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
8930 return;
8931 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
8932 abort ();
8933
8934 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
8935 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
8936 return;
8937
8938 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
8939 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
8940 code, and thus is not emitted. */
8941 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
8942
8943 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8944 {
8945 case ADDRESSOF:
8946 /* The address of a variable that was optimized away; don't emit
8947 anything. */
8948 break;
8949
8950 case CONST_INT:
8951 case CONST_DOUBLE:
8952 case CONST_STRING:
8953 case SYMBOL_REF:
8954 case LABEL_REF:
8955 case CONST:
8956 case PLUS:
8957 /* DECL_RTL could be (plus (reg ...) (const_int ...)) */
8958 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
8959 break;
8960
8961 case MEM:
8962 case REG:
8963 case SUBREG:
8964 case CONCAT:
8965 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, rtl);
8966 break;
8967
8968 default:
8969 abort ();
8970 }
8971 }
8972
8973 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
8974 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
8975 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
8976
8977 static void
8978 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl)
8979 dw_die_ref var_die;
8980 tree decl;
8981 {
8982 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
8983 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
8984
8985 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init
8986 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type) == null_pointer_node)
8987 /* OK */;
8988 else
8989 return;
8990
8991 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8992 {
8993 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8994 if (host_integerp (init, 0))
8995 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
8996 tree_low_cst (init, 0));
8997 else
8998 add_AT_long_long (var_die, DW_AT_const_value,
8999 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (init),
9000 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (init));
9001 break;
9002
9003 default:;
9004 }
9005 }
9006
9007 /* Generate an DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
9008 the value of the attribute. */
9009
9010 static inline void
9011 add_name_attribute (die, name_string)
9012 dw_die_ref die;
9013 const char *name_string;
9014 {
9015 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
9016 {
9017 if (demangle_name_func)
9018 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
9019
9020 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
9021 }
9022 }
9023
9024 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
9025 a representation for that bound. */
9026
9027 static void
9028 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound)
9029 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
9030 enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr;
9031 tree bound;
9032 {
9033 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
9034 {
9035 case ERROR_MARK:
9036 return;
9037
9038 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
9039 case INTEGER_CST:
9040 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
9041 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
9042 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
9043 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
9044 /* use the default */
9045 ;
9046 else
9047 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
9048 break;
9049
9050 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9051 case NOP_EXPR:
9052 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9053 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9054 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
9055 break;
9056
9057 case SAVE_EXPR:
9058 /* If optimization is turned on, the SAVE_EXPRs that describe how to
9059 access the upper bound values may be bogus. If they refer to a
9060 register, they may only describe how to get at these values at the
9061 points in the generated code right after they have just been
9062 computed. Worse yet, in the typical case, the upper bound values
9063 will not even *be* computed in the optimized code (though the
9064 number of elements will), so these SAVE_EXPRs are entirely
9065 bogus. In order to compensate for this fact, we check here to see
9066 if optimization is enabled, and if so, we don't add an attribute
9067 for the (unknown and unknowable) upper bound. This should not
9068 cause too much trouble for existing (stupid?) debuggers because
9069 they have to deal with empty upper bounds location descriptions
9070 anyway in order to be able to deal with incomplete array types.
9071 Of course an intelligent debugger (GDB?) should be able to
9072 comprehend that a missing upper bound specification in an array
9073 type used for a storage class `auto' local array variable
9074 indicates that the upper bound is both unknown (at compile- time)
9075 and unknowable (at run-time) due to optimization.
9076
9077 We assume that a MEM rtx is safe because gcc wouldn't put the
9078 value there unless it was going to be used repeatedly in the
9079 function, i.e. for cleanups. */
9080 if (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)
9081 && (! optimize || GET_CODE (SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound)) == MEM))
9082 {
9083 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
9084 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
9085 rtx loc = SAVE_EXPR_RTL (bound);
9086
9087 /* If the RTL for the SAVE_EXPR is memory, handle the case where
9088 it references an outer function's frame. */
9089 if (GET_CODE (loc) == MEM)
9090 {
9091 rtx new_addr = fix_lexical_addr (XEXP (loc, 0), bound);
9092
9093 if (XEXP (loc, 0) != new_addr)
9094 loc = gen_rtx_MEM (GET_MODE (loc), new_addr);
9095 }
9096
9097 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9098 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
9099 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
9100 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9101 }
9102
9103 /* Else leave out the attribute. */
9104 break;
9105
9106 case VAR_DECL:
9107 case PARM_DECL:
9108 {
9109 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
9110
9111 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
9112 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
9113 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
9114 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
9115 later parameter. */
9116 if (decl_die != NULL)
9117 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9118 break;
9119 }
9120
9121 default:
9122 {
9123 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
9124 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
9125
9126 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
9127 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
9128
9129 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound, 0);
9130 if (loc == NULL)
9131 break;
9132
9133 if (current_function_decl == 0)
9134 ctx = comp_unit_die;
9135 else
9136 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
9137
9138 /* If we weren't able to find a context, it's most likely the case
9139 that we are processing the return type of the function. So
9140 make a SAVE_EXPR to point to it and have the limbo DIE code
9141 find the proper die. The save_expr function doesn't always
9142 make a SAVE_EXPR, so do it ourselves. */
9143 if (ctx == 0)
9144 bound = build (SAVE_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (bound), bound,
9145 current_function_decl, NULL_TREE);
9146
9147 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
9148 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9149 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
9150 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
9151
9152 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
9153 break;
9154 }
9155 }
9156 }
9157
9158 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
9159 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
9160
9161 static void
9162 add_subscript_info (type_die, type)
9163 dw_die_ref type_die;
9164 tree type;
9165 {
9166 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9167 unsigned dimension_number;
9168 #endif
9169 tree lower, upper;
9170 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
9171
9172 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
9173 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
9174 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
9175 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
9176 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
9177 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
9178 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
9179 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
9180
9181 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
9182 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
9183 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
9184 gen_array_type_die. */
9185 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9186 for (dimension_number = 0;
9187 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
9188 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
9189 #endif
9190 {
9191 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
9192
9193 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
9194 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
9195 here. */
9196 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
9197 if (domain)
9198 {
9199 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
9200 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
9201 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
9202
9203 /* define the index type. */
9204 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
9205 {
9206 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
9207 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
9208 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
9209 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
9210 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
9211 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
9212 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
9213 ;
9214 else
9215 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
9216 type_die);
9217 }
9218
9219 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
9220 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
9221 dimension arr(N:*)
9222 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
9223 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
9224 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
9225
9226 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
9227 if (upper)
9228 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
9229 }
9230
9231 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
9232 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
9233 bounds. */
9234 }
9235 }
9236
9237 static void
9238 add_byte_size_attribute (die, tree_node)
9239 dw_die_ref die;
9240 tree tree_node;
9241 {
9242 unsigned size;
9243
9244 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
9245 {
9246 case ERROR_MARK:
9247 size = 0;
9248 break;
9249 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
9250 case RECORD_TYPE:
9251 case UNION_TYPE:
9252 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
9253 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
9254 break;
9255 case FIELD_DECL:
9256 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
9257 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
9258 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
9259 even for bit-fields. */
9260 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9261 break;
9262 default:
9263 abort ();
9264 }
9265
9266 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
9267 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
9268 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
9269 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
9270 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
9271 }
9272
9273 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
9274 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
9275 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
9276 bit-field itself.
9277
9278 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9279 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9280 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9281 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
9282 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
9283 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
9284
9285 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
9286 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
9287 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
9288
9289 static inline void
9290 add_bit_offset_attribute (die, decl)
9291 dw_die_ref die;
9292 tree decl;
9293 {
9294 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
9295 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9296 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9297 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
9298 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
9299 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
9300
9301 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
9302 if (!type
9303 || TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL)
9304 abort ();
9305
9306 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
9307 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
9308 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
9309 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
9310 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
9311 return;
9312
9313 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9314
9315 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
9316 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
9317 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
9318 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
9319 below must take account of these differences. */
9320 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
9321 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
9322
9323 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
9324 {
9325 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
9326 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9327 }
9328
9329 bit_offset
9330 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9331 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
9332 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
9333
9334 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
9335 }
9336
9337 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
9338 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
9339
9340 static inline void
9341 add_bit_size_attribute (die, decl)
9342 dw_die_ref die;
9343 tree decl;
9344 {
9345 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
9346 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FIELD_DECL
9347 || ! DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
9348 abort ();
9349
9350 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
9351 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
9352 }
9353
9354 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
9355 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
9356
9357 static inline void
9358 add_prototyped_attribute (die, func_type)
9359 dw_die_ref die;
9360 tree func_type;
9361 {
9362 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
9363 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
9364 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
9365 }
9366
9367 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
9368 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
9369 equate table. */
9370
9371 static inline void
9372 add_abstract_origin_attribute (die, origin)
9373 dw_die_ref die;
9374 tree origin;
9375 {
9376 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
9377
9378 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
9379 {
9380 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
9381 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
9382 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
9383
9384 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
9385 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
9386 tree fn = origin;
9387
9388 if (TYPE_P (fn))
9389 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
9390
9391 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
9392 if (fn)
9393 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
9394 }
9395
9396 if (DECL_P (origin))
9397 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
9398 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
9399 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
9400
9401 if (origin_die == NULL)
9402 abort ();
9403
9404 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
9405 }
9406
9407 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
9408
9409 static inline void
9410 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (die, func_decl)
9411 dw_die_ref die;
9412 tree func_decl;
9413 {
9414 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
9415 {
9416 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
9417
9418 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
9419 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
9420 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
9421 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
9422 0));
9423
9424 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
9425 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
9426 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
9427 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
9428 }
9429 }
9430 \f
9431 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
9432
9433 static void
9434 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl)
9435 dw_die_ref die;
9436 tree decl;
9437 {
9438 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
9439
9440 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
9441 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
9442 }
9443
9444 /* Add an DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
9445 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
9446
9447 static void
9448 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, decl)
9449 dw_die_ref die;
9450 tree decl;
9451 {
9452 tree decl_name;
9453
9454 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
9455 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
9456 {
9457 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
9458 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
9459 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
9460
9461 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
9462 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
9463 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
9464 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
9465 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
9466 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
9467 }
9468
9469 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9470 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
9471 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
9472 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
9473 {
9474 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
9475 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
9476 VARRAY_PUSH_RTX (used_rtx_varray, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
9477 }
9478 #endif
9479 }
9480
9481 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
9482
9483 static void
9484 push_decl_scope (scope)
9485 tree scope;
9486 {
9487 VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (decl_scope_table, scope);
9488 }
9489
9490 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
9491
9492 static inline void
9493 pop_decl_scope ()
9494 {
9495 if (VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) <= 0)
9496 abort ();
9497
9498 VARRAY_POP (decl_scope_table);
9499 }
9500
9501 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
9502 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
9503 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
9504 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
9505 the current active scope. */
9506
9507 static dw_die_ref
9508 scope_die_for (t, context_die)
9509 tree t;
9510 dw_die_ref context_die;
9511 {
9512 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
9513 tree containing_scope;
9514 int i;
9515
9516 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
9517 if (! TYPE_P (t))
9518 abort ();
9519
9520 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
9521
9522 /* Ignore namespaces for the moment. */
9523 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
9524 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
9525
9526 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
9527 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
9528 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
9529 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
9530 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
9531
9532 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
9533 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
9534 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
9535 {
9536 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
9537 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
9538 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
9539 for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
9540 if (VARRAY_TREE (decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
9541 break;
9542
9543 if (i < 0)
9544 {
9545 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
9546 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope))
9547 abort ();
9548
9549 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
9550 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
9551 }
9552 else
9553 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
9554 }
9555 else
9556 scope_die = context_die;
9557
9558 return scope_die;
9559 }
9560
9561 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
9562
9563 static inline int
9564 local_scope_p (context_die)
9565 dw_die_ref context_die;
9566 {
9567 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
9568 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
9569 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
9570 return 1;
9571
9572 return 0;
9573 }
9574
9575 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
9576
9577 static inline int
9578 class_scope_p (context_die)
9579 dw_die_ref context_die;
9580 {
9581 return (context_die
9582 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
9583 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
9584 }
9585
9586 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
9587 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
9588 by 'type', and adds an DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
9589
9590 static void
9591 add_type_attribute (object_die, type, decl_const, decl_volatile, context_die)
9592 dw_die_ref object_die;
9593 tree type;
9594 int decl_const;
9595 int decl_volatile;
9596 dw_die_ref context_die;
9597 {
9598 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
9599 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
9600
9601 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
9602 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
9603 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
9604 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
9605 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
9606 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
9607 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
9608
9609 if (code == ERROR_MARK
9610 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
9611 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
9612 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
9613 || code == VOID_TYPE)
9614 return;
9615
9616 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
9617 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
9618 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
9619 context_die);
9620
9621 if (type_die != NULL)
9622 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
9623 }
9624
9625 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
9626 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
9627 was declared without a tag. */
9628
9629 static const char *
9630 type_tag (type)
9631 tree type;
9632 {
9633 const char *name = 0;
9634
9635 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
9636 {
9637 tree t = 0;
9638
9639 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
9640 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
9641 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
9642
9643 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
9644 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
9645 involved. */
9646 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
9647 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
9648 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
9649
9650 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
9651 if (t != 0)
9652 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
9653 }
9654
9655 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
9656 }
9657
9658 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
9659 for bit field types. */
9660
9661 static inline tree
9662 member_declared_type (member)
9663 tree member;
9664 {
9665 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
9666 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
9667 }
9668
9669 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
9670 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
9671
9672 #if 0
9673 static const char *
9674 decl_start_label (decl)
9675 tree decl;
9676 {
9677 rtx x;
9678 const char *fnname;
9679
9680 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
9681 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
9682 abort ();
9683
9684 x = XEXP (x, 0);
9685 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
9686 abort ();
9687
9688 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
9689 return fnname;
9690 }
9691 #endif
9692 \f
9693 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
9694 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
9695 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
9696
9697 static void
9698 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die)
9699 tree type;
9700 dw_die_ref context_die;
9701 {
9702 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
9703 dw_die_ref array_die;
9704 tree element_type;
9705
9706 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
9707 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
9708 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
9709 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9710 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
9711 #endif
9712
9713 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
9714
9715 #if 0
9716 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
9717 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
9718 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
9719 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
9720 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
9721 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
9722 for multidimensional arrays. */
9723 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
9724 #endif
9725
9726 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9727 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
9728 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
9729 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
9730 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9731 else
9732 #endif
9733 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
9734
9735 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
9736 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
9737
9738 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
9739 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
9740
9741 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
9742 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
9743 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
9744 add_subscript_info. */
9745 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9746 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
9747 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
9748
9749 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
9750 #endif
9751
9752 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
9753 }
9754
9755 static void
9756 gen_set_type_die (type, context_die)
9757 tree type;
9758 dw_die_ref context_die;
9759 {
9760 dw_die_ref type_die
9761 = new_die (DW_TAG_set_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
9762
9763 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
9764 add_type_attribute (type_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
9765 }
9766
9767 #if 0
9768 static void
9769 gen_entry_point_die (decl, context_die)
9770 tree decl;
9771 dw_die_ref context_die;
9772 {
9773 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
9774 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
9775
9776 if (origin != NULL)
9777 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
9778 else
9779 {
9780 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
9781 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
9782 0, 0, context_die);
9783 }
9784
9785 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
9786 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
9787 else
9788 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
9789 }
9790 #endif
9791
9792 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
9793 emit full debugging info for them. */
9794
9795 static void
9796 retry_incomplete_types ()
9797 {
9798 int i;
9799
9800 for (i = VARRAY_ACTIVE_SIZE (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9801 gen_type_die (VARRAY_TREE (incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
9802 }
9803
9804 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
9805
9806 static void
9807 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die)
9808 tree type;
9809 dw_die_ref context_die;
9810 {
9811 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
9812
9813 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
9814 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
9815 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
9816 }
9817
9818 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
9819
9820 static void
9821 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die)
9822 tree type;
9823 dw_die_ref context_die;
9824 {
9825 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
9826
9827 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
9828 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
9829 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
9830 }
9831
9832 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
9833
9834 static void
9835 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die)
9836 tree type;
9837 dw_die_ref context_die;
9838 {
9839 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
9840
9841 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
9842 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
9843 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
9844 }
9845
9846 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
9847 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
9848 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
9849 DIE. */
9850
9851 static void
9852 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die)
9853 tree type;
9854 dw_die_ref context_die;
9855 {
9856 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
9857
9858 if (type_die == NULL)
9859 {
9860 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
9861 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
9862 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
9863 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
9864 }
9865 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
9866 return;
9867 else
9868 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
9869
9870 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
9871 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
9872 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
9873 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
9874 {
9875 tree link;
9876
9877 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
9878 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
9879 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
9880 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
9881
9882 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
9883 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
9884 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
9885 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
9886
9887 for (link = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
9888 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
9889 {
9890 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
9891
9892 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
9893 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
9894
9895 if (host_integerp (TREE_VALUE (link), 0))
9896 {
9897 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (TREE_VALUE (link)) < 0)
9898 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9899 tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 0));
9900 else
9901 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
9902 tree_low_cst (TREE_VALUE (link), 0));
9903 }
9904 }
9905 }
9906 else
9907 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9908 }
9909
9910 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
9911 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
9912 type.
9913
9914 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
9915 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
9916 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
9917 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
9918 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
9919 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
9920 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
9921 argument type of some subprogram type. */
9922
9923 static dw_die_ref
9924 gen_formal_parameter_die (node, context_die)
9925 tree node;
9926 dw_die_ref context_die;
9927 {
9928 dw_die_ref parm_die
9929 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
9930 tree origin;
9931
9932 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
9933 {
9934 case 'd':
9935 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
9936 if (origin != NULL)
9937 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
9938 else
9939 {
9940 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
9941 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
9942 TREE_READONLY (node),
9943 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
9944 context_die);
9945 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
9946 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
9947 }
9948
9949 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
9950 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
9951 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node);
9952
9953 break;
9954
9955 case 't':
9956 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
9957 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
9958 break;
9959
9960 default:
9961 abort ();
9962 }
9963
9964 return parm_die;
9965 }
9966
9967 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
9968 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
9969
9970 static void
9971 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl_or_type, context_die)
9972 tree decl_or_type;
9973 dw_die_ref context_die;
9974 {
9975 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
9976 }
9977
9978 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
9979 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
9980 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
9981 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
9982
9983 static void
9984 gen_formal_types_die (function_or_method_type, context_die)
9985 tree function_or_method_type;
9986 dw_die_ref context_die;
9987 {
9988 tree link;
9989 tree formal_type = NULL;
9990 tree first_parm_type;
9991 tree arg;
9992
9993 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
9994 {
9995 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
9996 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
9997 }
9998 else
9999 arg = NULL_TREE;
10000
10001 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
10002
10003 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
10004 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
10005 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
10006 {
10007 dw_die_ref parm_die;
10008
10009 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
10010 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
10011 break;
10012
10013 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
10014 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
10015 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
10016 && link == first_parm_type)
10017 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
10018 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10019
10020 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
10021 if (arg)
10022 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
10023 }
10024
10025 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
10026 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
10027 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
10028 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
10029
10030 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
10031 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
10032 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
10033 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
10034 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
10035 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
10036 }
10037
10038 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
10039 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
10040 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
10041 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
10042 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
10043
10044 static void
10045 gen_type_die_for_member (type, member, context_die)
10046 tree type, member;
10047 dw_die_ref context_die;
10048 {
10049 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
10050
10051 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
10052 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
10053 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
10054 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
10055 {
10056 if (decl_ultimate_origin (member))
10057 abort ();
10058
10059 push_decl_scope (type);
10060 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
10061 gen_subprogram_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
10062 else
10063 gen_variable_die (member, lookup_type_die (type));
10064
10065 pop_decl_scope ();
10066 }
10067 }
10068
10069 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
10070 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
10071
10072 static void
10073 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl)
10074 tree decl;
10075 {
10076 dw_die_ref old_die;
10077 tree save_fn;
10078 tree context;
10079 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
10080
10081 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
10082 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
10083
10084 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10085 if (old_die && get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10086 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
10087 return;
10088
10089 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
10090 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
10091 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10092 {
10093 context = decl_class_context (decl);
10094 if (context)
10095 gen_type_die_for_member
10096 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
10097 }
10098
10099 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
10100 save_fn = current_function_decl;
10101 current_function_decl = decl;
10102
10103 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
10104 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
10105 if (! was_abstract)
10106 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
10107
10108 current_function_decl = save_fn;
10109 }
10110
10111 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
10112 block-local). */
10113
10114 static void
10115 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die)
10116 tree decl;
10117 dw_die_ref context_die;
10118 {
10119 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10120 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10121 dw_die_ref subr_die;
10122 rtx fp_reg;
10123 tree fn_arg_types;
10124 tree outer_scope;
10125 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10126 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
10127 || class_scope_p (context_die));
10128
10129 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
10130 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
10131 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
10132 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
10133 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
10134
10135 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
10136 if (origin && declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
10137 {
10138 origin = NULL;
10139 if (old_die)
10140 abort ();
10141 }
10142
10143 if (origin != NULL)
10144 {
10145 if (declaration && ! local_scope_p (context_die))
10146 abort ();
10147
10148 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
10149 inline function. */
10150 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
10151 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
10152
10153 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10154 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
10155 }
10156 else if (old_die)
10157 {
10158 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
10159
10160 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
10161 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
10162 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
10163 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
10164 && !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10165 {
10166 /* ??? This can happen if there is a bug in the program, for
10167 instance, if it has duplicate function definitions. Ideally,
10168 we should detect this case and ignore it. For now, if we have
10169 already reported an error, any error at all, then assume that
10170 we got here because of an input error, not a dwarf2 bug. */
10171 if (errorcount)
10172 return;
10173 abort ();
10174 }
10175
10176 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
10177 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
10178 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
10179 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
10180 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
10181 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
10182 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
10183 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
10184 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
10185 || (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
10186 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10187 == (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl)))))
10188 {
10189 subr_die = old_die;
10190
10191 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the parm types. */
10192 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
10193 remove_children (subr_die);
10194 }
10195 else
10196 {
10197 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10198 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10199 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
10200 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10201 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10202 != (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
10203 add_AT_unsigned
10204 (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
10205 }
10206 }
10207 else
10208 {
10209 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
10210
10211 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10212 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
10213
10214 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
10215 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10216 {
10217 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
10218 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10219 0, 0, context_die);
10220 }
10221
10222 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
10223 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10224 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10225
10226 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10227 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10228 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10229 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10230 }
10231
10232 if (declaration)
10233 {
10234 if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10235 {
10236 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10237
10238 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
10239 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
10240 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
10241 handled above. The two may come from the same source text. */
10242 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10243 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10244 }
10245 }
10246 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10247 {
10248 if (DECL_INLINE (decl) && !flag_no_inline)
10249 {
10250 /* ??? Checking DECL_DEFER_OUTPUT is correct for static
10251 inline functions, but not for extern inline functions.
10252 We can't get this completely correct because information
10253 about whether the function was declared inline is not
10254 saved anywhere. */
10255 if (DECL_DEFER_OUTPUT (decl))
10256 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
10257 else
10258 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
10259 }
10260 else
10261 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
10262
10263 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10264 }
10265 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
10266 {
10267 if (!old_die || !get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
10268 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
10269
10270 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
10271 current_funcdef_number);
10272 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
10273 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10274 current_funcdef_number);
10275 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
10276
10277 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
10278 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
10279
10280 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10281 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
10282 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
10283 #endif
10284
10285 /* Define the "frame base" location for this routine. We use the
10286 frame pointer or stack pointer registers, since the RTL for local
10287 variables is relative to one of them. */
10288 fp_reg
10289 = frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx : stack_pointer_rtx;
10290 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, reg_loc_descriptor (fp_reg));
10291
10292 #if 0
10293 /* ??? This fails for nested inline functions, because context_display
10294 is not part of the state saved/restored for inline functions. */
10295 if (current_function_needs_context)
10296 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
10297 lookup_static_chain (decl));
10298 #endif
10299 }
10300
10301 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
10302 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
10303 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
10304 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
10305 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
10306 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
10307 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
10308 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
10309 an ellipsis at the end. */
10310
10311 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
10312 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
10313 its formal parameters. */
10314 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10315 ;
10316 else if (declaration)
10317 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
10318 else
10319 {
10320 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters */
10321 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
10322 tree parm;
10323
10324 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
10325 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
10326 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
10327 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
10328 {
10329 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
10330 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
10331 "__builtin_va_alist"))
10332 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
10333 else
10334 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
10335 }
10336
10337 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
10338 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
10339 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
10340 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
10341 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
10342 parameters at all. */
10343 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
10344 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
10345 {
10346 /* this is the prototyped case, check for ... */
10347 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
10348 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
10349 }
10350 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
10351 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
10352 }
10353
10354 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
10355 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
10356 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10357
10358 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
10359 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
10360 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
10361 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
10362 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
10363 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
10364 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
10365
10366 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
10367 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
10368 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
10369 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
10370 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
10371 constructor function. */
10372 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
10373 {
10374 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
10375 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
10376
10377 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10378 if (current_function_has_inlines)
10379 {
10380 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
10381 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
10382 {
10383 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
10384 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
10385 }
10386 }
10387 #endif
10388 }
10389 }
10390
10391 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
10392
10393 static void
10394 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die)
10395 tree decl;
10396 dw_die_ref context_die;
10397 {
10398 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10399 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
10400
10401 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
10402 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
10403 || class_scope_p (context_die));
10404
10405 if (origin != NULL)
10406 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
10407
10408 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
10409 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
10410
10411 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
10412 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
10413 sharing them.
10414
10415 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
10416 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl)
10417 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
10418 {
10419 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
10420 add_AT_die_ref (var_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10421 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
10422 {
10423 unsigned file_index = lookup_filename (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (decl));
10424
10425 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
10426 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
10427
10428 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
10429 != (unsigned) DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl))
10430
10431 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line,
10432 DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl));
10433 }
10434 }
10435 else
10436 {
10437 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
10438 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
10439 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
10440
10441 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10442 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
10443
10444 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10445 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10446
10447 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10448 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10449 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10450 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10451 }
10452
10453 if (declaration)
10454 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10455
10456 if (class_scope_p (context_die) || DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10457 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
10458
10459 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10460 {
10461 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
10462 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
10463 }
10464 else
10465 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
10466 }
10467
10468 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
10469
10470 static void
10471 gen_label_die (decl, context_die)
10472 tree decl;
10473 dw_die_ref context_die;
10474 {
10475 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10476 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
10477 rtx insn;
10478 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10479
10480 if (origin != NULL)
10481 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
10482 else
10483 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
10484
10485 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10486 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
10487 else
10488 {
10489 insn = DECL_RTL (decl);
10490
10491 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
10492 eliminated because of various optimisations. We still emit them
10493 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
10494 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CODE_LABEL
10495 || ((GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE
10496 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL)))
10497 {
10498 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
10499 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
10500 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
10501 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
10502 it if it ever does happen. */
10503 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn))
10504 abort ();
10505
10506 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
10507 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10508 }
10509 }
10510 }
10511
10512 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
10513
10514 static void
10515 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
10516 tree stmt;
10517 dw_die_ref context_die;
10518 int depth;
10519 {
10520 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
10521 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10522
10523 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
10524 {
10525 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
10526 {
10527 tree chain;
10528
10529 add_AT_range_list (stmt_die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
10530
10531 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
10532 do
10533 {
10534 add_ranges (chain);
10535 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
10536 }
10537 while (chain);
10538 add_ranges (NULL);
10539 }
10540 else
10541 {
10542 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
10543 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10544 add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10545 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
10546 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10547 add_AT_lbl_id (stmt_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
10548 }
10549 }
10550
10551 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
10552 }
10553
10554 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
10555
10556 static void
10557 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
10558 tree stmt;
10559 dw_die_ref context_die;
10560 int depth;
10561 {
10562 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
10563 {
10564 dw_die_ref subr_die
10565 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
10566 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
10567 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10568
10569 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. */
10570 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
10571
10572 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
10573 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
10574 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10575 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
10576 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
10577 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
10578 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
10579 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
10580 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
10581 }
10582 }
10583
10584 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
10585
10586 static void
10587 gen_field_die (decl, context_die)
10588 tree decl;
10589 dw_die_ref context_die;
10590 {
10591 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
10592
10593 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
10594 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
10595 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
10596 context_die);
10597
10598 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
10599 {
10600 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10601 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10602 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10603 }
10604
10605 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
10606 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
10607
10608 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
10609 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10610
10611 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
10612 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10613 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
10614 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
10615 }
10616
10617 #if 0
10618 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
10619 Use modified_type_die instead.
10620 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
10621 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
10622
10623 static void
10624 gen_pointer_type_die (type, context_die)
10625 tree type;
10626 dw_die_ref context_die;
10627 {
10628 dw_die_ref ptr_die
10629 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10630
10631 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
10632 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
10633 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
10634 }
10635
10636 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
10637 Use modified_type_die instead.
10638 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
10639 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
10640
10641 static void
10642 gen_reference_type_die (type, context_die)
10643 tree type;
10644 dw_die_ref context_die;
10645 {
10646 dw_die_ref ref_die
10647 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10648
10649 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
10650 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
10651 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
10652 }
10653 #endif
10654
10655 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
10656
10657 static void
10658 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die)
10659 tree type;
10660 dw_die_ref context_die;
10661 {
10662 dw_die_ref ptr_die
10663 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
10664 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10665
10666 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
10667 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10668 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
10669 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
10670 }
10671
10672 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
10673
10674 static dw_die_ref
10675 gen_compile_unit_die (filename)
10676 const char *filename;
10677 {
10678 dw_die_ref die;
10679 char producer[250];
10680 const char *wd = getpwd ();
10681 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
10682 int language;
10683
10684 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
10685 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
10686
10687 if (wd != NULL && filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
10688 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10689
10690 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
10691
10692 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10693 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
10694 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
10695 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
10696 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
10697 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
10698 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
10699 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10700 strcat (producer, " -g");
10701 #endif
10702
10703 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
10704
10705 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
10706 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
10707 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
10708 language = DW_LANG_Ada83;
10709 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
10710 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
10711 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
10712 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
10713 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
10714 language = DW_LANG_Java;
10715 else if (flag_traditional)
10716 language = DW_LANG_C;
10717 else
10718 language = DW_LANG_C89;
10719
10720 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
10721 return die;
10722 }
10723
10724 /* Generate a DIE for a string type. */
10725
10726 static void
10727 gen_string_type_die (type, context_die)
10728 tree type;
10729 dw_die_ref context_die;
10730 {
10731 dw_die_ref type_die
10732 = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10733
10734 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
10735
10736 /* ??? Fudge the string length attribute for now.
10737 TODO: add string length info. */
10738 #if 0
10739 string_length_attribute (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
10740 bound_representation (upper_bound, 0, 'u');
10741 #endif
10742 }
10743
10744 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
10745
10746 static void
10747 gen_inheritance_die (binfo, context_die)
10748 tree binfo;
10749 dw_die_ref context_die;
10750 {
10751 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
10752
10753 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
10754 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
10755
10756 if (TREE_VIA_VIRTUAL (binfo))
10757 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10758
10759 if (TREE_VIA_PUBLIC (binfo))
10760 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
10761 else if (TREE_VIA_PROTECTED (binfo))
10762 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
10763 }
10764
10765 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
10766
10767 static void
10768 gen_member_die (type, context_die)
10769 tree type;
10770 dw_die_ref context_die;
10771 {
10772 tree member;
10773 dw_die_ref child;
10774
10775 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
10776 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
10777 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
10778 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
10779 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
10780 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
10781 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
10782 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
10783 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
10784 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
10785 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
10786
10787 /* First output info about the base classes. */
10788 if (TYPE_BINFO (type) && TYPE_BINFO_BASETYPES (type))
10789 {
10790 tree bases = TYPE_BINFO_BASETYPES (type);
10791 int n_bases = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (bases);
10792 int i;
10793
10794 for (i = 0; i < n_bases; i++)
10795 gen_inheritance_die (TREE_VEC_ELT (bases, i), context_die);
10796 }
10797
10798 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
10799 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
10800 {
10801 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
10802 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
10803 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
10804 do put them in the right order. */
10805
10806 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
10807 if (child)
10808 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
10809 else
10810 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
10811 }
10812
10813 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
10814 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
10815 {
10816 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
10817 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
10818 continue;
10819
10820 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
10821 if (child)
10822 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
10823 else
10824 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
10825 }
10826 }
10827
10828 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
10829 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
10830 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
10831
10832 static void
10833 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die)
10834 tree type;
10835 dw_die_ref context_die;
10836 {
10837 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
10838 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
10839 int nested = 0;
10840 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
10841 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
10842 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
10843
10844 if (type_die && ! complete)
10845 return;
10846
10847 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
10848 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
10849 nested = 1;
10850
10851 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
10852
10853 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
10854 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
10855 {
10856 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
10857
10858 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
10859 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
10860 scope_die, type);
10861 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
10862 if (old_die)
10863 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_specification, old_die);
10864 else
10865 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
10866 }
10867 else
10868 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
10869
10870 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
10871 then give a list of members. */
10872 if (complete)
10873 {
10874 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
10875 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
10876 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
10877 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
10878 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
10879 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
10880
10881 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
10882 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
10883 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
10884 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
10885
10886 push_decl_scope (type);
10887 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
10888 pop_decl_scope ();
10889
10890 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
10891 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
10892 {
10893 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
10894
10895 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
10896 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10897 lookup_type_die (vtype));
10898 }
10899 }
10900 else
10901 {
10902 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10903
10904 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
10905 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
10906 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
10907 VARRAY_PUSH_TREE (incomplete_types, type);
10908 }
10909 }
10910
10911 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
10912
10913 static void
10914 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die)
10915 tree type;
10916 dw_die_ref context_die;
10917 {
10918 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10919 dw_die_ref subr_die
10920 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
10921 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
10922
10923 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
10924 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
10925 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
10926 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
10927 }
10928
10929 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition */
10930
10931 static void
10932 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die)
10933 tree decl;
10934 dw_die_ref context_die;
10935 {
10936 dw_die_ref type_die;
10937 tree origin;
10938
10939 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
10940 return;
10941
10942 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
10943 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
10944 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
10945 if (origin != NULL)
10946 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
10947 else
10948 {
10949 tree type;
10950
10951 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
10952 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
10953 {
10954 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
10955
10956 if (type == TREE_TYPE (decl))
10957 abort ();
10958 else
10959 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
10960 }
10961 else
10962 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10963
10964 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
10965 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
10966 }
10967
10968 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
10969 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
10970 }
10971
10972 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
10973
10974 static void
10975 gen_type_die (type, context_die)
10976 tree type;
10977 dw_die_ref context_die;
10978 {
10979 int need_pop;
10980
10981 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
10982 return;
10983
10984 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
10985 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
10986 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
10987 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
10988 cloned type itself). */
10989 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
10990 type = type_main_variant (type);
10991
10992 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
10993 return;
10994
10995 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
10996 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
10997 {
10998 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
10999 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
11000 return;
11001 }
11002
11003 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11004 {
11005 case ERROR_MARK:
11006 break;
11007
11008 case POINTER_TYPE:
11009 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
11010 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
11011 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
11012 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
11013 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
11014 statement. */
11015 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11016
11017 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
11018 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
11019 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11020 break;
11021
11022 case OFFSET_TYPE:
11023 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
11024 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
11025 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
11026
11027 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
11028 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11029
11030 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
11031 itself. */
11032 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
11033 break;
11034
11035 case SET_TYPE:
11036 gen_type_die (TYPE_DOMAIN (type), context_die);
11037 gen_set_type_die (type, context_die);
11038 break;
11039
11040 case FILE_TYPE:
11041 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11042 abort (); /* No way to represent these in Dwarf yet! */
11043 break;
11044
11045 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
11046 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
11047 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11048 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
11049 break;
11050
11051 case METHOD_TYPE:
11052 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
11053 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11054 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
11055 break;
11056
11057 case ARRAY_TYPE:
11058 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == CHAR_TYPE)
11059 {
11060 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11061 gen_string_type_die (type, context_die);
11062 }
11063 else
11064 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
11065 break;
11066
11067 case VECTOR_TYPE:
11068 gen_type_die (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type), context_die);
11069 break;
11070
11071 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11072 case RECORD_TYPE:
11073 case UNION_TYPE:
11074 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11075 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
11076 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
11077 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
11078 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
11079 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
11080 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
11081 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
11082 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
11083 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
11084 {
11085 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
11086
11087 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
11088 return;
11089
11090 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
11091 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
11092 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
11093 need_pop = 1;
11094 }
11095 else
11096 need_pop = 0;
11097
11098 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
11099 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
11100 else
11101 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
11102
11103 if (need_pop)
11104 pop_decl_scope ();
11105
11106 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
11107 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
11108 when appropriate. */
11109 return;
11110
11111 case VOID_TYPE:
11112 case INTEGER_TYPE:
11113 case REAL_TYPE:
11114 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
11115 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
11116 case CHAR_TYPE:
11117 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
11118 break;
11119
11120 case LANG_TYPE:
11121 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
11122 break;
11123
11124 default:
11125 abort ();
11126 }
11127
11128 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11129 }
11130
11131 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
11132
11133 static void
11134 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (type, context_die)
11135 tree type;
11136 dw_die_ref context_die;
11137 {
11138 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
11139 return;
11140
11141 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
11142 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
11143 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
11144 type now. */
11145 if (type != type_main_variant (type))
11146 abort ();
11147
11148 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
11149 an instance of an unresolved type. */
11150
11151 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11152 {
11153 case ERROR_MARK:
11154 break;
11155
11156 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11157 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
11158 break;
11159
11160 case RECORD_TYPE:
11161 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
11162 break;
11163
11164 case UNION_TYPE:
11165 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11166 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
11167 break;
11168
11169 default:
11170 abort ();
11171 }
11172 }
11173
11174 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
11175 things which are local to the given block. */
11176
11177 static void
11178 gen_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth)
11179 tree stmt;
11180 dw_die_ref context_die;
11181 int depth;
11182 {
11183 int must_output_die = 0;
11184 tree origin;
11185 tree decl;
11186 enum tree_code origin_code;
11187
11188 /* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
11189 if (stmt == NULL_TREE || !TREE_USED (stmt)
11190 || (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt) && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)))
11191 return;
11192
11193 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
11194 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
11195 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
11196 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
11197 {
11198 tree sub;
11199
11200 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
11201 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
11202
11203 return;
11204 }
11205
11206 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
11207 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
11208 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
11209 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
11210 the current block. */
11211 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
11212 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
11213
11214 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
11215 block. */
11216 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
11217 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
11218 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
11219 must_output_die = 1;
11220 else
11221 {
11222 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
11223 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
11224 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
11225 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
11226 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
11227 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
11228 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
11229 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
11230 {
11231 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
11232 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
11233 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11234 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
11235 as being a "significant" one. */
11236 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL);
11237 else
11238 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
11239 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
11240 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
11241 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11242 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
11243 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
11244 {
11245 must_output_die = 1;
11246 break;
11247 }
11248 }
11249 }
11250
11251 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
11252 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
11253 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
11254 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
11255 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
11256 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
11257 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
11258 if (must_output_die)
11259 {
11260 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
11261 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11262 else
11263 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
11264 }
11265 else
11266 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
11267 }
11268
11269 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
11270 all of its sub-blocks. */
11271
11272 static void
11273 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth)
11274 tree stmt;
11275 dw_die_ref context_die;
11276 int depth;
11277 {
11278 tree decl;
11279 tree subblocks;
11280
11281 /* Ignore blocks never really used to make RTL. */
11282 if (stmt == NULL_TREE || ! TREE_USED (stmt))
11283 return;
11284
11285 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
11286 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
11287 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
11288 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
11289 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11290 {
11291 dw_die_ref die;
11292
11293 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11294 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11295 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
11296 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11297 else
11298 die = NULL;
11299
11300 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
11301 add_child_die (context_die, die);
11302 else
11303 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
11304 }
11305
11306 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
11307 therein) of this block. */
11308 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
11309 subblocks != NULL;
11310 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
11311 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
11312 }
11313
11314 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
11315
11316 static inline int
11317 is_redundant_typedef (decl)
11318 tree decl;
11319 {
11320 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
11321 return 1;
11322
11323 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11324 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
11325 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11326 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
11327 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
11328 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
11329 return 1;
11330
11331 return 0;
11332 }
11333
11334 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
11335
11336 static void
11337 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die)
11338 tree decl;
11339 dw_die_ref context_die;
11340 {
11341 tree origin;
11342
11343 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
11344 return;
11345
11346 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
11347 {
11348 case ERROR_MARK:
11349 break;
11350
11351 case CONST_DECL:
11352 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
11353 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
11354 break;
11355
11356 case FUNCTION_DECL:
11357 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
11358 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
11359 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
11360 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
11361 break;
11362
11363 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
11364 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
11365 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
11366
11367 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
11368 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
11369 else if (DECL_INLINE (decl) && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11370 && ! class_scope_p (context_die)
11371 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
11372 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
11373 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
11374 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11375 {
11376 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
11377 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
11378 }
11379
11380 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
11381 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11382 {
11383 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
11384 have described its return type. */
11385 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
11386
11387 /* And its virtual context. */
11388 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11389 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
11390
11391 /* And its containing type. */
11392 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
11393 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
11394 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
11395 }
11396
11397 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
11398 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
11399 break;
11400
11401 case TYPE_DECL:
11402 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11403 actual typedefs. */
11404 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11405 break;
11406
11407 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
11408 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
11409 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
11410 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
11411 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
11412 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
11413 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
11414 {
11415 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11416 break;
11417 }
11418
11419 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
11420 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11421 else
11422 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
11423 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
11424 break;
11425
11426 case LABEL_DECL:
11427 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
11428 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
11429 break;
11430
11431 case VAR_DECL:
11432 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11433 variable declarations or definitions. */
11434 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11435 break;
11436
11437 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
11438 object. */
11439 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11440
11441 /* And its containing type. */
11442 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
11443 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
11444 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
11445
11446 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
11447 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
11448 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
11449 function. */
11450 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11451 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
11452 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
11453 else
11454 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
11455 break;
11456
11457 case FIELD_DECL:
11458 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
11459 anonymous unions. */
11460 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
11461 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE)
11462 {
11463 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
11464 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
11465 }
11466 break;
11467
11468 case PARM_DECL:
11469 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
11470 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
11471 break;
11472
11473 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
11474 /* Ignore for now. */
11475 break;
11476
11477 default:
11478 abort ();
11479 }
11480 }
11481
11482 static void
11483 mark_limbo_die_list (ptr)
11484 void *ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11485 {
11486 limbo_die_node *node;
11487 for (node = limbo_die_list; node ; node = node->next)
11488 ggc_mark_tree (node->created_for);
11489 }
11490 \f
11491 /* Add Ada "use" clause information for SGI Workshop debugger. */
11492
11493 void
11494 dwarf2out_add_library_unit_info (filename, context_list)
11495 const char *filename;
11496 const char *context_list;
11497 {
11498 unsigned int file_index;
11499
11500 if (filename != NULL)
11501 {
11502 dw_die_ref unit_die = new_die (DW_TAG_module, comp_unit_die, NULL);
11503 tree context_list_decl
11504 = build_decl (LABEL_DECL, get_identifier (context_list),
11505 void_type_node);
11506
11507 TREE_PUBLIC (context_list_decl) = TRUE;
11508 add_name_attribute (unit_die, context_list);
11509 file_index = lookup_filename (filename);
11510 add_AT_unsigned (unit_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11511 add_pubname (context_list_decl, unit_die);
11512 }
11513 }
11514
11515 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
11516 compilation proper has finished. */
11517
11518 static void
11519 dwarf2out_global_decl (decl)
11520 tree decl;
11521 {
11522 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
11523 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
11524 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
11525 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
11526 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
11527 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11528 }
11529
11530 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
11531
11532 void
11533 dwarf2out_decl (decl)
11534 tree decl;
11535 {
11536 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
11537
11538 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
11539 {
11540 case ERROR_MARK:
11541 return;
11542
11543 case FUNCTION_DECL:
11544 /* Ignore this FUNCTION_DECL if it refers to a builtin declaration of a
11545 builtin function. Explicit programmer-supplied declarations of
11546 these same functions should NOT be ignored however. */
11547 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && DECL_BUILT_IN (decl))
11548 return;
11549
11550 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
11551 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
11552 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
11553 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
11554 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
11555 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
11556 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
11557 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
11558 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
11559 with the definition of the function.
11560
11561 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
11562 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
11563 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
11564 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
11565 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
11566 translation unit (an thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
11567 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
11568 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
11569 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
11570 that they *are* definitions).
11571
11572 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
11573 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
11574 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
11575 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
11576 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
11577 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11578 return;
11579
11580 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
11581 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
11582 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
11583 if (decl_function_context (decl))
11584 context_die = NULL;
11585 break;
11586
11587 case VAR_DECL:
11588 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
11589 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
11590 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
11591 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
11592 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
11593 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
11594 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
11595 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
11596 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
11597 return;
11598
11599 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
11600 variable declarations or definitions. */
11601 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11602 return;
11603 break;
11604
11605 case TYPE_DECL:
11606 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
11607 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
11608 return;
11609
11610 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
11611 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
11612 if (DECL_SOURCE_LINE (decl) == 0)
11613 {
11614 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
11615 comparisons have. */
11616 if ((get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language)
11617 == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus)
11618 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
11619 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
11620 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
11621
11622 return;
11623 }
11624
11625 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
11626 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11627 return;
11628
11629 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
11630 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
11631 if (decl_function_context (decl))
11632 context_die = NULL;
11633
11634 break;
11635
11636 default:
11637 return;
11638 }
11639
11640 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
11641 }
11642
11643 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
11644 a lexical block. */
11645
11646 static void
11647 dwarf2out_begin_block (line, blocknum)
11648 unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11649 unsigned int blocknum;
11650 {
11651 function_section (current_function_decl);
11652 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
11653 }
11654
11655 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
11656 lexical block. */
11657
11658 static void
11659 dwarf2out_end_block (line, blocknum)
11660 unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11661 unsigned int blocknum;
11662 {
11663 function_section (current_function_decl);
11664 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
11665 }
11666
11667 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
11668 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
11669
11670 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
11671 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
11672 we may end up calling them anyway. */
11673
11674 static bool
11675 dwarf2out_ignore_block (block)
11676 tree block;
11677 {
11678 tree decl;
11679
11680 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
11681 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
11682 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
11683 return 0;
11684
11685 return 1;
11686 }
11687
11688 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
11689 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
11690 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
11691 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
11692 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
11693 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
11694 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
11695 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
11696 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
11697 all searches. */
11698
11699 static unsigned
11700 lookup_filename (file_name)
11701 const char *file_name;
11702 {
11703 unsigned i;
11704
11705 /* ??? Why isn't DECL_SOURCE_FILE left null instead. */
11706 if (strcmp (file_name, "<internal>") == 0
11707 || strcmp (file_name, "<built-in>") == 0)
11708 return 0;
11709
11710 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
11711 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
11712 if (file_table.last_lookup_index != 0)
11713 if (0 == strcmp (file_name,
11714 file_table.table[file_table.last_lookup_index]))
11715 return file_table.last_lookup_index;
11716
11717 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table */
11718 for (i = 1; i < file_table.in_use; i++)
11719 if (strcmp (file_name, file_table.table[i]) == 0)
11720 {
11721 file_table.last_lookup_index = i;
11722 return i;
11723 }
11724
11725 /* Prepare to add a new table entry by making sure there is enough space in
11726 the table to do so. If not, expand the current table. */
11727 if (i == file_table.allocated)
11728 {
11729 file_table.allocated = i + FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11730 file_table.table = (char **)
11731 xrealloc (file_table.table, file_table.allocated * sizeof (char *));
11732 }
11733
11734 /* Add the new entry to the end of the filename table. */
11735 file_table.table[i] = xstrdup (file_name);
11736 file_table.in_use = i + 1;
11737 file_table.last_lookup_index = i;
11738
11739 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
11740 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u \"%s\"\n", i, file_name);
11741
11742 return i;
11743 }
11744
11745 static void
11746 init_file_table ()
11747 {
11748 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the file_table. */
11749 file_table.table = (char **) xcalloc (FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (char *));
11750 file_table.allocated = FILE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11751
11752 /* Skip the first entry - file numbers begin at 1. */
11753 file_table.in_use = 1;
11754 file_table.last_lookup_index = 0;
11755 }
11756
11757 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
11758 and record information relating to this source line, in
11759 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
11760
11761 static void
11762 dwarf2out_source_line (line, filename)
11763 unsigned int line;
11764 const char *filename;
11765 {
11766 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
11767 {
11768 function_section (current_function_decl);
11769
11770 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
11771 if (flag_debug_asm)
11772 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
11773 filename, line);
11774
11775 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
11776 {
11777 unsigned file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
11778
11779 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
11780 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
11781
11782 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
11783 line_info_table_in_use++;
11784
11785 /* Indicate that multiple line number tables exist. */
11786 if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
11787 separate_line_info_table_in_use++;
11788 }
11789 else if (DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
11790 {
11791 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
11792 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
11793 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
11794
11795 /* expand the line info table if necessary */
11796 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
11797 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
11798 {
11799 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11800 separate_line_info_table
11801 = (dw_separate_line_info_ref)
11802 xrealloc (separate_line_info_table,
11803 separate_line_info_table_allocated
11804 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
11805 }
11806
11807 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
11808 line_info
11809 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
11810 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
11811 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
11812 line_info->function = current_funcdef_number;
11813 }
11814 else
11815 {
11816 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
11817
11818 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
11819 line_info_table_in_use);
11820
11821 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
11822 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
11823 {
11824 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11825 line_info_table
11826 = (dw_line_info_ref)
11827 xrealloc (line_info_table,
11828 (line_info_table_allocated
11829 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
11830 }
11831
11832 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
11833 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
11834 line_info->dw_file_num = lookup_filename (filename);
11835 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
11836 }
11837 }
11838 }
11839
11840 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
11841
11842 static void
11843 dwarf2out_start_source_file (lineno, filename)
11844 unsigned int lineno;
11845 const char *filename;
11846 {
11847 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
11848 {
11849 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
11850 dw_die_ref bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
11851 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
11852 }
11853
11854 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
11855 {
11856 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11857 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
11858 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
11859 lineno);
11860 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lookup_filename (filename),
11861 "Filename we just started");
11862 }
11863 }
11864
11865 /* Record the end of a source file. */
11866
11867 static void
11868 dwarf2out_end_source_file (lineno)
11869 unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11870 {
11871 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
11872 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
11873 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
11874
11875 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
11876 {
11877 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11878 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
11879 }
11880 }
11881
11882 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
11883 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
11884 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
11885
11886 static void
11887 dwarf2out_define (lineno, buffer)
11888 unsigned lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11889 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11890 {
11891 static int initialized = 0;
11892 if (!initialized)
11893 {
11894 dwarf2out_start_source_file (0, primary_filename);
11895 initialized = 1;
11896 }
11897
11898 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
11899 {
11900 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11901 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
11902 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
11903 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
11904 }
11905 }
11906
11907 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
11908 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
11909 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
11910
11911 static void
11912 dwarf2out_undef (lineno, buffer)
11913 unsigned lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11914 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
11915 {
11916 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
11917 {
11918 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
11920 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
11921 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
11922 }
11923 }
11924
11925 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
11926
11927 static void
11928 dwarf2out_init (main_input_filename)
11929 const char *main_input_filename;
11930 {
11931 init_file_table ();
11932
11933 /* Remember the name of the primary input file. */
11934 primary_filename = main_input_filename;
11935
11936 /* Add it to the file table first, under the assumption that we'll
11937 be emitting line number data for it first, which avoids having
11938 to add an initial DW_LNS_set_file. */
11939 lookup_filename (main_input_filename);
11940
11941 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_die_table. */
11942 decl_die_table
11943 = (dw_die_ref *) xcalloc (DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT, sizeof (dw_die_ref));
11944 decl_die_table_allocated = DECL_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11945 decl_die_table_in_use = 0;
11946
11947 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
11948 VARRAY_TREE_INIT (decl_scope_table, 256, "decl_scope_table");
11949 ggc_add_tree_varray_root (&decl_scope_table, 1);
11950
11951 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
11952 abbrev_die_table
11953 = (dw_die_ref *) xcalloc (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT,
11954 sizeof (dw_die_ref));
11955 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11956 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
11957 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
11958
11959 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
11960 line_info_table
11961 = (dw_line_info_ref) xcalloc (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT,
11962 sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
11963 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11964
11965 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused */
11966 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
11967
11968 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
11969 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
11970 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
11971 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
11972 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. */
11973 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (main_input_filename);
11974
11975 VARRAY_TREE_INIT (incomplete_types, 64, "incomplete_types");
11976 ggc_add_tree_varray_root (&incomplete_types, 1);
11977
11978 VARRAY_RTX_INIT (used_rtx_varray, 32, "used_rtx_varray");
11979 ggc_add_rtx_varray_root (&used_rtx_varray, 1);
11980
11981 ggc_add_root (&limbo_die_list, 1, 1, mark_limbo_die_list);
11982
11983 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
11984 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
11985 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
11986 if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
11987 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
11988 else
11989 strcpy (text_section_label, stripattributes (TEXT_SECTION_NAME));
11990
11991 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
11992 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
11993 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
11994 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
11995 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
11996 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
11997 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
11998 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
11999 named_section_flags (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12000 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
12001 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12002 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
12003
12004 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12005 {
12006 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12007 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
12008 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12009 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
12010 }
12011
12012 if (DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL)
12013 {
12014 text_section ();
12015 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
12016 }
12017 }
12018
12019 /* Allocate a string in .debug_str hash table. */
12020
12021 static hashnode
12022 indirect_string_alloc (tab)
12023 hash_table *tab ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12024 {
12025 struct indirect_string_node *node;
12026
12027 node = xmalloc (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
12028 node->refcount = 0;
12029 node->form = 0;
12030 node->label = NULL;
12031
12032 return (hashnode) node;
12033 }
12034
12035 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
12036 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
12037
12038 static int
12039 output_indirect_string (pfile, h, v)
12040 struct cpp_reader *pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12041 hashnode h;
12042 const PTR v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12043 {
12044 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) h;
12045
12046 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
12047 {
12048 named_section_flags (DEBUG_STR_SECTION, DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS);
12049 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
12050 assemble_string ((const char *) HT_STR (&node->id),
12051 HT_LEN (&node->id) + 1);
12052 }
12053
12054 return 1;
12055 }
12056
12057 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
12058 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
12059
12060 static void
12061 dwarf2out_finish (input_filename)
12062 const char *input_filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
12063 {
12064 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
12065 dw_die_ref die = 0;
12066
12067 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
12068 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
12069 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
12070 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
12071 instance. */
12072 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
12073 {
12074 next_node = node->next;
12075 die = node->die;
12076
12077 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
12078 {
12079 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
12080 tree context;
12081
12082 if (origin)
12083 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
12084 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
12085 ;
12086 /* If this was an expression for a bound involved in a function
12087 return type, it may be a SAVE_EXPR for which we weren't able
12088 to find a DIE previously. So try now. */
12089 else if (node->created_for
12090 && TREE_CODE (node->created_for) == SAVE_EXPR
12091 && 0 != (origin = (lookup_decl_die
12092 (SAVE_EXPR_CONTEXT
12093 (node->created_for)))))
12094 add_child_die (origin, die);
12095 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
12096 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
12097 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
12098 else if (node->created_for
12099 && ((DECL_P (node->created_for)
12100 && (context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for)))
12101 || (TYPE_P (node->created_for)
12102 && (context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for))))
12103 && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12104 {
12105 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
12106 nested function can be optimized away, which results
12107 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
12108 with the return type of that nested function. Force
12109 this to be a child of the containing function. */
12110 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
12111 if (! origin)
12112 abort ();
12113 add_child_die (origin, die);
12114 }
12115 else
12116 abort ();
12117 }
12118
12119 free (node);
12120 }
12121
12122 limbo_die_list = NULL;
12123
12124 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
12125 emit full debugging info for them. */
12126 retry_incomplete_types ();
12127
12128 /* We need to reverse all the dies before break_out_includes, or
12129 we'll see the end of an include file before the beginning. */
12130 reverse_all_dies (comp_unit_die);
12131
12132 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
12133 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
12134 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
12135 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
12136
12137 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
12138 that have children. */
12139 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
12140 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12141 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
12142
12143 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
12144 text_section ();
12145 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
12146
12147 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
12148 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
12149 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
12150 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
12151 examining the file. */
12152 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
12153 {
12154 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12155 output_line_info ();
12156 }
12157
12158 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
12159 if (have_location_lists)
12160 {
12161 /* Output the location lists info. */
12162 named_section_flags (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12163 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
12164 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
12165 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
12166 output_location_lists (die);
12167 have_location_lists = 0;
12168 }
12169
12170 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
12171 in .text. */
12172 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use == 0)
12173 {
12174 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
12175 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
12176 }
12177
12178 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
12179 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
12180 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
12181 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
12182
12183 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
12184 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
12185 debug_line_section_label);
12186
12187 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12188 add_AT_lbl_offset (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
12189
12190 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
12191 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
12192 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
12193 output_comp_unit (node->die);
12194
12195 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die);
12196
12197 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
12198 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12199 output_abbrev_section ();
12200
12201 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
12202 if (pubname_table_in_use)
12203 {
12204 named_section_flags (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12205 output_pubnames ();
12206 }
12207
12208 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
12209 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
12210 if (fde_table_in_use)
12211 {
12212 named_section_flags (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12213 output_aranges ();
12214 }
12215
12216 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
12217 if (ranges_table_in_use)
12218 {
12219 named_section_flags (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12220 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
12221 output_ranges ();
12222 }
12223
12224 /* Have to end the primary source file. */
12225 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
12226 {
12227 named_section_flags (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION, SECTION_DEBUG);
12228 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
12229 }
12230
12231 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
12232 table too. */
12233 if (debug_str_hash)
12234 ht_forall (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
12235 }
12236 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO || DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO */
This page took 0.562373 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.